jtag: replace command "jtag_reset" with "adapter [de]assert"
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
541 @* The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB debug probe. The XDS110
542 stand-alone probe has the additional ability to supply voltage to the target
543 board via its AUX FUNCTIONS port. Use the
544 @command{xds110_supply_voltage <millivolts>} command to set the voltage. 0 turns
545 off the supply. Otherwise, the supply can be set to any value in the range 1800
546 to 3600 millivolts.
547 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
548 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
549 @end itemize
550
551 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
552
553 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
554 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
555 these on the market.
556
557 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
558 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
559 of USB-based ones.
560
561 @itemize @bullet
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
564 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
565
566 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
567 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
568 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
569
570 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler2}
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
575
576 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
577 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
578
579 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
580 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
581
582 @item @b{arm-jtag}
583 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
584
585 @item @b{chameleon}
586 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
587
588 @item @b{Triton}
589 @* Unknown.
590
591 @item @b{Lattice}
592 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
593 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
594
595 @item @b{flashlink}
596 @* From STMicroelectronics;
597 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
598
599 @end itemize
600
601 @section Other...
602 @itemize @bullet
603
604 @item @b{ep93xx}
605 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
606
607 @item @b{at91rm9200}
608 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
609
610 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
611 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
612
613 @item @b{imx_gpio}
614 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
615
616 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
617 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
618 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
619
620 @end itemize
621
622 @node About Jim-Tcl
623 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
624 @cindex Jim-Tcl
625 @cindex tcl
626
627 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
628 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
629 command interpreter.
630
631 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
632 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
633 much of anything about Tcl.
634 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
635
636 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
637 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
638 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
639 OpenOCD mailing list.
640
641 @itemize @bullet
642 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
643 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
644 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
645 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
646 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
647 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
648
649 @item @b{Missing Features}
650 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
651 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
652 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
653 enabled in OpenOCD.
654
655 @item @b{Scripts}
656 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
657 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
658 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
659
660 @item @b{Commands}
661 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
662 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
663 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
664 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
665
666 @item @b{Historical Note}
667 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
668 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
669 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
670 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
671
672 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
673 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
674 @end itemize
675
676 @node Running
677 @chapter Running
678 @cindex command line options
679 @cindex logfile
680 @cindex directory search
681
682 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
683 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
684 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
685 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
686 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
687 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
688 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
689
690 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
691 tell it how each debug session should work.
692 The @option{--help} option shows:
693 @verbatim
694 bash$ openocd --help
695
696 --help | -h display this help
697 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
698 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
699 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
700 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
701 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
702 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
703 --command | -c run <command>
704 @end verbatim
705
706 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
707 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
708 To specify one or more different
709 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
710
711 @example
712 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
713 @end example
714
715 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
716 @enumerate
717 @item the current directory,
718 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
719 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
720 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
721 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
722 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
723 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
724 @end enumerate
725 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
726
727 @quotation Note
728 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
729 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
730 @end quotation
731
732 @section Simple setup, no customization
733
734 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
735 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
736 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
737 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
738 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
739
740 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
741 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
742 the server with some variation of one of the following:
743
744 @example
745 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
746 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
747 @end example
748
749 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
750 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
751 If all goes well you'll see output something like
752
753 @example
754 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
755 For bug reports, read
756 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
757 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
758 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
759 @end example
760
761 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
762 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
763 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
764
765 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
766
767 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
768 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
769 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
770 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
771 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
772 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
773 ensure that this always succeeds.
774 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
775 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
776 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
777 and then shut down without acting as a server.
778
779 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
780 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
781 those channels.
782
783 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
784 the @option{-d} option.
785
786 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
787 @option{-c} command line switch.
788
789 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
790 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
791 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
792 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
793 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
794 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
795 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
796
797 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
798 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
799
800 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
801 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
802 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
803 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
804
805 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
806 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
807
808 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
809 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
810 and start the OpenOCD server.
811 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
812 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
813 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
814 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
815
816 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
817
818 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
819 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
820 and a USB cable on the other.
821 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
822 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
823
824 @enumerate
825 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
826 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
827 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
828 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
829 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
830 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
831 debugging host.
832
833 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
834 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
835 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
836 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
837 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
838
839 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
840 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
841 with 1.2 Volt boards.
842
843 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
844 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
845 ways to connect the cable.
846 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
847 Be sure it's firmly connected.
848
849 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
850 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
851 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
852 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
853 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
854 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
855 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
856 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
857
858 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
859 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
860 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
861 but are tedious to set up.
862 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
863 adapter signals to the right board pins.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
866 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
867 you are using to run OpenOCD.
868 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
869
870 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
871 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
872 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
873 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
874
875 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
876 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
877 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
878
879 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
880 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
881 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
882 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
883
884 @end enumerate
885
886 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
887 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
888 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
889
890 @section Project Directory
891
892 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
893
894 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
895 single directory for your work with a given board.
896 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
897 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
898 files accessed through semihosting,
899 and for code you upload to the target board.
900 It is also the natural place to write files,
901 such as log files and data you download from the board.
902
903 @section Configuration Basics
904
905 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
906 a variety of ways you can mix them.
907 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
908
909 @itemize
910 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
911 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
912 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
913 @end itemize
914
915 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
916 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
917 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
918
919 @example
920 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
921
922 # GDB can also flash my flash!
923 gdb_memory_map enable
924 gdb_flash_program enable
925
926 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
927 @end example
928
929 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
930
931 @example
932 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
933 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
934 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
935 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
936 @end example
937
938 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
939 each supporting a different development task.
940 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
941 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
942
943 @quotation Important
944 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
945 problems with how it treats variables.
946 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
947 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
948 that can be tested in a later script.
949 @end quotation
950
951 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
952 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
953 to simplify your work.
954
955 @section User Config Files
956 @cindex config file, user
957 @cindex user config file
958 @cindex config file, overview
959
960 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
961 in one place.
962 One of the following will match your situation best:
963
964 @itemize
965 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
966 provided by someone else.
967 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
968 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
969 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
970 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
971 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
972 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
973
974 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
975 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
976
977 @enumerate
978 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
979 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
980 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
981 @end enumerate
982
983 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
984 The first is an interface config file.
985 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
986 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
987 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
988 meet your deadline:
989
990 @example
991 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
992 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
993 @end example
994
995 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
996 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
997 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
998 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
999
1000 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1001 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1002 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1003 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1004 target and board
1005 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1006 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1007
1008 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1009 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1010 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1011 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1012
1013 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1014 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1015 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1016 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1017 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1018
1019 @quotation Note
1020 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1021 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1022 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1023 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1024 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1025 @end quotation
1026
1027 @item
1028 You may may need to write some C code.
1029 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1030 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1031 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1032 a new chip architecture.
1033 @end itemize
1034
1035 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1036 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1037 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1038
1039 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1040 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1041 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1042 @itemize
1043
1044 @item
1045 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1046 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1047 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1048 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1049
1050 @item
1051 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1052 @cindex vector_catch
1053 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1054 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1055 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1056 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1057 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1058 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1059
1060 @item
1061 You might need to override some defaults.
1062 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1063 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1064
1065 @item
1066 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1067 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1068 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1069 @end itemize
1070
1071 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1072
1073 A few project-specific utility
1074 routines may well speed up your work.
1075 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1076
1077 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1078 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1079 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1080 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1081 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1082 may help:
1083
1084 @example
1085 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1086 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1087 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1088 # Leave the CPU halted.
1089 reset init
1090
1091 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1092 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1093
1094 # Start running.
1095 resume 0x20000000
1096 @}
1097 @end example
1098
1099 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1100 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1101 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1102 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1103 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1104
1105 @example
1106 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1107 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1108 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1109 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1110 reset init
1111
1112 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1113 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1114 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1115 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1116 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1117 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1118 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1119
1120 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1121 reset run
1122 @}
1123 @end example
1124
1125 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1126 from NAND.
1127 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1128 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1129 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1130
1131 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1132 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1133
1134 @section Target Software Changes
1135
1136 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1137 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1138 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1139 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1140 handling issues like:
1141
1142 @itemize @bullet
1143
1144 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1145 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1146 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1147 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1148 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1149 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1150 your debug sessions.
1151
1152 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1153 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1154 That might however be your only option.
1155
1156 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1157 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1158 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1159 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1160 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1161 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1162 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1163 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1164 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1165 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1166 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1167 instead of the whole thing.
1168 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1169 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1170
1171 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1172 @cindex ARM semihosting
1173 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1174 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1175 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1176 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1177 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1178 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1179 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1180 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1181 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1182 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1183 NAND or SPI flash.
1184
1185 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1186 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1187 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1188 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1189 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1190
1191 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1192 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1193 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1194 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1195 registers which can be used to change various features including
1196 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1197 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1198 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1199 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1200 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1201
1202 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1203 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1204 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1205 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1206 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1207
1208 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1209 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1210 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1211 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1212 early code execution can be debugged
1213 or firmware can be replaced.
1214
1215 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1216 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1217 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1218 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1219 operations like writing to memory.)
1220
1221 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1222 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1223 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1224 various kinds of message.
1225 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1226
1227 @end itemize
1228
1229 @section Target Hardware Setup
1230
1231 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1232 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1233 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1234 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1235 working with.}
1236
1237 Common issues include:
1238
1239 @itemize @bullet
1240
1241 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1242 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1243 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1244 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1245 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1246 or one from a daughtercard).
1247 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1248 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1249
1250 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1251 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1252 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1253 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1254 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1255 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1256
1257 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1258 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1259 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1260 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1261 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1262
1263
1264 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1265 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1266 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1267 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1268 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1269 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1270 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1271
1272 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1273 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1274 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1275 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1276 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1277
1278 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1279 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1280 used to start booting.
1281
1282 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1283 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1284 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1285 multiple audio codec chips).
1286 This interacts with software
1287 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1288 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1289 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1290 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1291 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1292 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1293 audio or video codecs are used.
1294
1295 @end itemize
1296
1297 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1298 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1299 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1300 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1301 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1302 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1303 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1304 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1305 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1306 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1307
1308
1309 @node Config File Guidelines
1310 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1311
1312 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1313 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1314 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1315 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1316
1317 You should find the following directories under
1318 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1319 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1320 @itemize @bullet
1321 @item @file{interface} ...
1322 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1323 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1324 @item @file{board} ...
1325 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1326 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1327
1328 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1329 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1330 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1331 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1332 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1333 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1334 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1335 a CPU and an FPGA.
1336 @item @file{target} ...
1337 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1338 on a chip
1339 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1340 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1341 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1342 the target config file defines all of them.
1343 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1344 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1345 @end itemize
1346
1347 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1348 file may override features in any of the above files by
1349 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1350 commands specific to their situation.
1351
1352 @section Interface Config Files
1353
1354 The user config file
1355 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1356
1357 @example
1358 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1359 @end example
1360
1361 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1362 in use today with OpenOCD.
1363 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1364 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1365
1366 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1367 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1368 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1369 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1370 and need to provide a driver for it.
1371
1372 @section Board Config Files
1373 @cindex config file, board
1374 @cindex board config file
1375
1376 The user config file
1377 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1378
1379 @example
1380 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1381 @end example
1382
1383 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1384 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1385 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1386
1387 @enumerate
1388 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1389 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1390 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1391 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1392 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1393 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1394 @end enumerate
1395
1396 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1397 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1398 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1399 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1400
1401 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1402 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1403 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1404 configuration works.
1405
1406 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1407
1408 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1409 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1410 convention on how to use certain variables.
1411
1412 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1413 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1414 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1415 used at will within a target configuration file.
1416
1417 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1418 for a board with three chips:
1419
1420 @example
1421 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1422 set CHIPNAME network
1423 set ENDIAN big
1424 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1425 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1426 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1427 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1428
1429 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1430 set CHIPNAME video
1431 set ENDIAN little
1432 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1433 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1434 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1435 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1436
1437 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1438 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1439 unset ENDIAN
1440 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1441 @end example
1442
1443 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1444 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1445 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1446 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1447 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1448 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1449 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1450 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1451
1452 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1453 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1454 naming collisions.
1455
1456 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1457 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1458 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1459 up other clocks and peripherals.
1460
1461 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1462 @cindex variable names
1463
1464 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1465 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1466 one such chip (as shown above).
1467 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1468 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1469 to promote consistency and
1470 so that board files can override target defaults.
1471
1472 Inputs to target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1476 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1477 tap identifier dotted names.
1478 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1479 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1480 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1481 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1482 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1483 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1484 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1485 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1486 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1487 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1488 @end itemize
1489
1490 Outputs from target config files include:
1491
1492 @itemize @bullet
1493 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1494 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1495 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1496 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1497 specific to that board and that target.
1498 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1499 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1503 @cindex event, reset-init
1504 @cindex reset-init handler
1505
1506 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1507 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1508 fully set up yet.
1509 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1510 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1511 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1512 handler is one of the most important.
1513
1514 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1515 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1516 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1517 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1518 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1519
1520 @quotation Note
1521 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1522 are included here.
1523 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1524 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1525 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1526 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1527 @end quotation
1528
1529 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1530 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1531 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1532 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1533 those as parameters.
1534 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1535 and disabling the watchdog.
1536 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1537 the next developer doing such work.
1538 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1539
1540 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1541 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1542 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1543 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1544
1545 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1546
1547 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1548 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1549 a low JTAG clock rate.
1550 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1551 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1552 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1553 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1554 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1555 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1556 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1557
1558 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1559 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1560 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1561 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1562 which might be less than that.
1563
1564 @quotation Warning
1565 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1566 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1567 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1568 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1569 @end quotation
1570
1571 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1572 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1573 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1574 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1575 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1576 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1577
1578 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1579 @subsection The init_board procedure
1580 @cindex init_board procedure
1581
1582 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1583 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1584 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1585 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1586 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1587 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1588 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1589 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1590 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1591 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1592 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1593 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1594
1595 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1596 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1597
1598 @example
1599 ### board_file.cfg ###
1600
1601 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1602 source [find target/target.cfg]
1603
1604 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1605 # enables fast on-board clock source
1606 # configures the chip to use it
1607 @}
1608
1609 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1610 proc init_board @{@} @{
1611 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1612
1613 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1614 adapter_khz 100
1615 @}
1616
1617 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1618 enable_fast_clock
1619 adapter_khz 10000
1620 @}
1621 @}
1622 @end example
1623
1624 @section Target Config Files
1625 @cindex config file, target
1626 @cindex target config file
1627
1628 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1629 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1630 more target config files like this:
1631
1632 @example
1633 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1634 @end example
1635
1636 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1637 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1638 In summary the target files should contain
1639
1640 @enumerate
1641 @item Set defaults
1642 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1643 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1644 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1645 @item On-Chip flash
1646 @end enumerate
1647
1648 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1649 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1650 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1651
1652 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1653 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1654 can talk to the chip.
1655 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1656 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1657 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1658 and other processing engines.
1659
1660 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1661
1662 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1663 letting board config files express environment-specific
1664 differences in how things should be set up.
1665
1666 @example
1667 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1668 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1669 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1670 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1671 @} else @{
1672 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1673 @}
1674
1675 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1676 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1677 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _ENDIAN little
1680 @}
1681
1682 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1683 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1684 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1685 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1686 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1689 @}
1690 @end example
1691 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1692
1693 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1694 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1695 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1696
1697 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1698 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1699 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1700
1701 @example
1702 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1703 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1704 @end example
1705
1706 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1707 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1708 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1709 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1710 for taps.
1711
1712 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1713 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1714 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1715 looks (in part) like this:
1716
1717 @example
1718 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1719 @end example
1720
1721 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1722 to source such a config file twice, with different
1723 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1724 it adds a different TAP each time.
1725
1726 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1727 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1728 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1729 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1730
1731 @example
1732 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1733 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1734 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1735 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1736 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1737 @end example
1738
1739 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1740 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1741
1742 @itemize
1743 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1744 plus a JRC to enable them
1745 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1746 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1747 is not currently used)
1748 @end itemize
1749
1750 @subsection Add CPU targets
1751
1752 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1753 GDB and other commands can use it.
1754 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1755 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1756 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1757 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1761 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1762 @end example
1763
1764 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1765 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1766 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1767 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1768 a work area if you can.
1769 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1770
1771 @example
1772 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1773 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1774 @end example
1775
1776 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1777 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1778 @cindex SMP
1779 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1780
1781 @example
1782 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1783 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1784 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1785 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1786 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1787 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1788 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1789 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1790 @end example
1791 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1792 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1793 @itemize @bullet
1794 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1795 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1796 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1797 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1798 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1799 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1800 @end itemize
1801
1802 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1803 command have been implemented.
1804 @itemize @bullet
1805 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1806 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1807 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1808 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1809 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1810 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1811 following example.
1812 @end itemize
1813
1814 @example
1815 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1816 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1817 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1818 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1819 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1820 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1821 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1822 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1823 > resume
1824 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1826 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1829 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1830 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1831 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1832 @end example
1833
1834
1835 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1836
1837 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1838 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1839 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1840
1841 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1842 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1843 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1844 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1845 both signals.
1846
1847 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1848 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1849 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1850 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1851 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1852 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1853 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1854 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1855 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1856 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1857 not available.)
1858
1859 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1860 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1861 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1862 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1863 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1864 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1865 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1866 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1867
1868 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1869 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1870 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1871 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1872 slower clock than they will use later.
1873 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1874 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1875 than they will use later.
1876 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1877
1878 @quotation Important
1879 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1880 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1881 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1882 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1883 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1884 @end quotation
1885
1886 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1887 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1888 @cindex init_targets procedure
1889
1890 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1891 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1892 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1893 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1894 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1895 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1896 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1897 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1898 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1899
1900 @example
1901 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1902
1903 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1904 # basic initialization procedure ...
1905 @}
1906
1907 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1908 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1909 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1910 @}
1911
1912 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1913
1914 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1919 @}
1920 @end example
1921
1922 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1923 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1924
1925 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1926
1927 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1928 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1929
1930 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1931 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1932 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1933
1934 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1935 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1936 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1938 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1939 events already assigned.
1940
1941 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1942
1943 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1944 special high speed download features - enable it.
1945
1946 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1947
1948 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1949 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1950 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1951 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1952 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1953 If you are using an external trace port,
1954 configure it in your board config file.
1955 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1956 configure it in your target config file.
1957
1958 @example
1959 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1960 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1961 @end example
1962
1963 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1964
1965 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1966
1967 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1968 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1969 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1970 the TARGET (chip) file.
1971
1972 Examples:
1973 @itemize @bullet
1974 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1975 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1976 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1977 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1978 @end itemize
1979
1980 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1981 @section Translating Configuration Files
1982 @cindex translation
1983 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1984 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1985 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1986 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1987 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1988 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1989
1990 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1991 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1992 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1993 convert other scripts later on.
1994
1995 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1996 replace job:
1997
1998 @example
1999 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2000 #
2001 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2002 #
2003 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2004 #
2005 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2006
2007 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2008 global TARGETNAME
2009
2010 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2011
2012 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2013 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2014 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2015 @}
2016 @end example
2017
2018
2019
2020 @node Server Configuration
2021 @chapter Server Configuration
2022 @cindex initialization
2023 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2024 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2025 supported.
2026
2027 @anchor{configurationstage}
2028 @section Configuration Stage
2029 @cindex configuration stage
2030 @cindex config command
2031
2032 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2033 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2034 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2035 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2036 inside startup scripts.
2037
2038 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2039 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2040 which may be issued interactively.
2041 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2042 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2043
2044 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2045 flash banks,
2046 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2047 and other basic setup.
2048 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2049 may access or activate TAPs.
2050 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2051 longer be issued.
2052
2053 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2054 @section Entering the Run Stage
2055
2056 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2057 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2058 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2059 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2060 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2061 You should see no errors at this point.
2062 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2063 commands you used to configure the server.
2064 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2065 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2066 on the scan chain.
2067
2068 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2069 become available.
2070 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2071 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2072 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2073 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2074 entry to the run stage.
2075
2076 @deffn {Config Command} init
2077 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2078 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2079 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2080 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2081 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2082 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2083
2084 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2085 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2086 configuration files and/or command line options.
2087
2088 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2089 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2090 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2091 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2092 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2093 @end deffn
2094
2095 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2096 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2097 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2098
2099 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2100 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2101 scan chain.
2102 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2103 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2104
2105 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2106 they return.
2107 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2108 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2109 @end deffn
2110
2111 @anchor{tcpipports}
2112 @section TCP/IP Ports
2113 @cindex TCP port
2114 @cindex server
2115 @cindex port
2116 @cindex security
2117 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2118 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2119 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2120
2121 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2122 access using one or more of these ports.
2123 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2124 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2125 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2126
2127 @anchor{gdb_port}
2128 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2129 @cindex GDB server
2130 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2131 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2132 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2133 the normal use cases.
2134
2135 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2136 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2137 disables the gdb server.
2138
2139 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2140 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2141
2142 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2143 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2144
2145 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2146 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2147 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2148
2149 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2150 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2151 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2152 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2153 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2154 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2155 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2156 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2157 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2158
2159 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2160 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2161 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2162 @end deffn
2163
2164 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2165 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2166 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2167 output from the Tcl engine.
2168 Intended as a machine interface.
2169 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2170 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2171 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2172 @end deffn
2173
2174 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2175 Specify or query the
2176 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2177 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2178 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2179 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2180 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2181 @end deffn
2182
2183 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2184 @section GDB Configuration
2185 @cindex GDB
2186 @cindex GDB configuration
2187 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2188 The ones listed here are static and global.
2189 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2190 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2191
2192 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2193 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2194 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2195 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2196 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2197 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2198 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2202 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2203 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2204 vFlash packet is received.
2205 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2206 @end deffn
2207
2208 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2209 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2210 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2211 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2212 for flash programming to work.
2213 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2214 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2218 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2219 by GDB memory read packets.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2221 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2222 @end deffn
2223
2224 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2225 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2226 packets report errors or not.
2227 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2228 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2229 @end deffn
2230
2231 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2232 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2233 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2234 @end deffn
2235
2236 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2237 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2238
2239 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2240 @end deffn
2241
2242 @anchor{eventpolling}
2243 @section Event Polling
2244
2245 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2246 where significant events can happen at any time.
2247 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2248 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2249 or to GDB.
2250
2251 Examples of such events include:
2252
2253 @itemize
2254 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2255 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2256 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2257 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2258 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2259 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2260 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2261 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2262 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2263 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2264 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2265 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2266 @end itemize
2267
2268 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2269 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2270 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2271 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2272 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2273
2274 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2275 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2276 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2277 to the various active targets.
2278 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2279 which is normally done in the background.
2280
2281 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2282 Poll the current target for its current state.
2283 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2284 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2285 specific information about the current state is printed.
2286 An optional parameter
2287 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2288
2289 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2290 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2291 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2292 @example
2293 > poll
2294 background polling: on
2295 target state: halted
2296 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2297 current mode: Supervisor
2298 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2299 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2300 >
2301 @end example
2302 @end deffn
2303
2304 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2305 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2306 @cindex config file, interface
2307 @cindex interface config file
2308
2309 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2310 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2311 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2312
2313 @quotation Note
2314 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2315 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2316 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2317 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2318 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2319 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2320 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2321 @end quotation
2322
2323 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2324 through commands in an interface configuration
2325 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2326 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2327
2328 @example
2329 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2330 @end example
2331
2332 These commands tell
2333 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2334 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2335
2336 @example
2337 # jlink interface
2338 interface jlink
2339 @end example
2340
2341 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2342
2343
2344 @section Interface Configuration
2345
2346 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2347 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2348 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2349
2350 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2351 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2352 target.
2353 @end deffn
2354
2355 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2356 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2357 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2358 @end deffn
2359 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2360 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2361 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2362 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2363 the hardware can support.
2364 @end deffn
2365
2366
2367
2368 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2369 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2370 @end deffn
2371
2372 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2373 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2374 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2375 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2376 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2377 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2378 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2379
2380 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @section Interface Drivers
2384
2385 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2386 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2387 available at run time.
2388
2389 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2390 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2391 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2392 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2393
2394 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2395 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2396 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2397 @end deffn
2398
2399 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2400 Displays status of RTCK option.
2401 Optionally sets that option first.
2402 @end deffn
2403 @end deffn
2404
2405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2406 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2407 This has one driver-specific command:
2408
2409 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2410 Logs some status
2411 @end deffn
2412 @end deffn
2413
2414 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2415 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2416 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2417 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2418 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2419 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2423 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2424
2425 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2426 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2427 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2428 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2429 @example
2430 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2431 @end example
2432 @end deffn
2433
2434 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2435 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2436 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2437 @end deffn
2438
2439 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2440 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2441 @end deffn
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2445 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2449 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2450 @end deffn
2451
2452 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2453 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2454 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2455
2456 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2457 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2458
2459 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2460 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2461
2462 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2463 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2464 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2465 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2466 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2467 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2468
2469 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2470 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2471 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2472 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2473 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2474
2475 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2476 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2477 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2478 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2479
2480 @itemize @minus
2481 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2482 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2483 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2484 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2485 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2486 switching data and direction as necessary
2487 @end itemize
2488
2489 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2490 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2491
2492 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2493 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2494 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2495 @example
2496 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2497 @end example
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2501 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2502 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2503 during device selection.
2504 @end deffn
2505
2506 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2507 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2508 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2509 is connected to the host.
2510 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2511 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2512 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2516 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2517 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2518
2519 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2520 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2521 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2522 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2523 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2524
2525 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2529 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2530 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2534 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2535 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2536 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2537 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2538 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2539 and initially asserted reset signals.
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2543 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2544 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2545 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2546 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2547 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2548 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2549 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2550 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2551 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2552 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2553
2554 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2555 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2556 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2557 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2558 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2559 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2560
2561 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2562 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2563 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2564 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2565 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2566 are always driven by the FTDI.
2567
2568 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2569 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2570 @var{name}.
2571 @end deffn
2572
2573 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2574 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2575 @itemize @minus
2576 @item @option{0}, drive low
2577 @item @option{1}, drive high
2578 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2579 @end itemize
2580 @end deffn
2581
2582 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2583 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2587 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2588
2589 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2590 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2591 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2592 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2593 @itemize @minus
2594 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2595 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2596 @end itemize
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2600 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2601
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2605 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2606 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2607 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2608
2609 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2610 @itemize @minus
2611 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2612 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2613 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2614 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2615 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2616 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2617 @end itemize
2618
2619 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2620 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2621 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2622 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2623 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2624 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2625 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2626 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2627
2628 FT232R
2629 @itemize @minus
2630 @item bit 7 - RI
2631 @item bit 6 - DCD
2632 @item bit 5 - DSR
2633 @item bit 4 - DTR
2634 @item bit 3 - CTS
2635 @item bit 2 - RTS
2636 @item bit 1 - RXD
2637 @item bit 0 - TXD
2638 @end itemize
2639
2640 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2641 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2644 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2645 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2649 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2650 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2651 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2655 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2656 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2660 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2664 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2668 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2672 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2676 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2677 @end deffn
2678
2679 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2680 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2681 @end deffn
2682
2683 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2684 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2685 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2686 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2687 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2688 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2689 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2690 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2691 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2692 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2693 @end deffn
2694
2695 @end deffn
2696
2697 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2698 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2699 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2700 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2701
2702 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2703 processors which are being simulated.
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2706 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2707 sockets instead of TCP.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2711 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2712 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2716 something like:
2717
2718 @example
2719 interface remote_bitbang
2720 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2721 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2722 @end example
2723
2724 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2725 named mysocket:
2726
2727 @example
2728 interface remote_bitbang
2729 remote_bitbang_port 0
2730 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2731 @end example
2732 @end deffn
2733
2734 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2735 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2736 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2737 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2738
2739 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2740 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2741 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2742 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2743 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2747 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2748 default values are used.
2749 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2750 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2751 @example
2752 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2753 @end example
2754 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2755 @example
2756 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2757 @end example
2758 @end deffn
2759
2760 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2761 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2762 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2763 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2764 target board.
2765
2766 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2767 @example
2768 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2769 reset_config srst_only
2770 @end example
2771 @end deffn
2772
2773 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2774 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2775 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2776 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2777 @end deffn
2778
2779 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2780 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2781 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2782 @end deffn
2783
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2787 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2788 This has one driver-specific command:
2789
2790 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2791 Display either the address of the I/O port
2792 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2793 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2794 This is a write-once setting.
2795 @end deffn
2796 @end deffn
2797
2798 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2799 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2800 transports.
2801
2802 @quotation Compatibility Note
2803 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2804 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2805 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2806 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2807 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2808 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2809 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2810 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2811 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2812 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2813 @end quotation
2814
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2816 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2817 states.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2820 Display free device internal memory.
2821 @end deffn
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2823 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2824 command version.
2825 @end deffn
2826 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2827 Display the device configuration.
2828 @end deffn
2829 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2830 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2831 power state.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2834 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2837 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2838 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2839 IP configuration.
2840 @end deffn
2841 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2842 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2843 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2844 @end deffn
2845 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2846 Reset the current configuration.
2847 @end deffn
2848 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2849 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2850 @end deffn
2851 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2852 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2853 pairs.
2854
2855 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2856 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2857 @example
2858 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2859 @end example
2860 @end deffn
2861 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2862 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2863 pairs.
2864
2865 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2866 @example
2867 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2868 77a90000
2869 @end example
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2872 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2873 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2874 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2875 instead.
2876
2877 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2878 @end deffn
2879 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2880 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2881 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2882
2883 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2884 @end deffn
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2888 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2889 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2890 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2891 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2892 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2893 configuration script.
2894
2895 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2896 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2897 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2898 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2899 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2900
2901 Known limitations:
2902 @itemize @bullet
2903 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2904 and 2.7 MHz.
2905 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2906 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2907 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2908 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2909 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2910 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2911 communications with the target.
2912 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2913 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2914 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2915 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2916 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2917 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2918 @end itemize
2919
2920 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2921 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2922 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2926 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2927 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2928 @end deffn
2929
2930 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2931 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2932 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2933 target as a side-effect.
2934 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2935 @end deffn
2936
2937 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2938 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2939 version, and target voltage.
2940 @end deffn
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2944 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2945 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2946 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2947 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2948
2949 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2950 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2951 This is a write-once setting.
2952 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2953
2954 @itemize @minus
2955 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2956 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2957 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2958 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2959 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2960 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2961 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2962 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2963 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2964 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2965 some versions of
2966 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2967 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2968 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2969 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2970 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2971 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2972 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2973 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2974 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2975 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2976 @end itemize
2977 @end deffn
2978
2979 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2980 Display either the address of the I/O port
2981 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2982 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2983 This is a write-once setting.
2984
2985 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2986 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2987 you may encounter a problem.
2988 @end deffn
2989
2990 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2991 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2992 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2993 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2994 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2995 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2996
2997 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2998 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2999 @quotation Tip
3000 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3001 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3002 @example
3003 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3004 > adapter_khz 500
3005 @end example
3006 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3007 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3008 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3009 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3010 large set of samples.
3011 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3012 @example
3013 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3014 @end example
3015 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
3016 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3017
3018 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3019 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3020 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3021 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3022 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3023 @end quotation
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3027 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3028 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3029 @end deffn
3030
3031 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3032 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3033
3034 @example
3035 interface parport
3036 parport_port 0x278
3037 parport_cable wiggler
3038 @end example
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3042 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3043 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3044 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3045 @end deffn
3046 @end deffn
3047
3048 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3049 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3050 @end deffn
3051
3052 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3053 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3054 @end deffn
3055
3056 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3057 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3058
3059 @quotation Note
3060 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3061 which are not currently documented here.
3062 @end quotation
3063 @end deffn
3064
3065 @anchor{hla_interface}
3066 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3067 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3068 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3069 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3070
3071 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3072 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3073 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3074 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3075 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3076
3077 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3078 Currently Not Supported.
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3082 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3083 @end deffn
3084
3085 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3086 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3087 @end deffn
3088
3089 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3090 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3094 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3095 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3096 @end deffn
3097 @end deffn
3098
3099 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3100 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3101 @end deffn
3102
3103 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3104 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3105 @end deffn
3106
3107 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3108 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3109 @end deffn
3110
3111 @quotation Note
3112 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3113 which are not currently documented here.
3114 @end quotation
3115
3116 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3117 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3118 No arguments: print status.
3119 @end deffn
3120
3121 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3122 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3123 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3124
3125 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3126 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3127 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3128 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3129 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3130 configuration on exit.
3131
3132 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3133 pinout.
3134
3135 @end deffn
3136
3137 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3138 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3139 of the one which is most popular.
3140
3141 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3142
3143 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3144 pinout.
3145
3146 @end deffn
3147
3148
3149 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3150 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3151 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3152
3153 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3154 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3155 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3156
3157 @itemize @minus
3158 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3159 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3160 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3161 @end itemize
3162 @end deffn
3163
3164 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3165 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3166 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3167 @end deffn
3168 @end deffn
3169
3170 @section Transport Configuration
3171 @cindex Transport
3172 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3173 and the debug adapter you are using,
3174 several transports may be available to
3175 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3176 @deffn Command {transport list}
3177 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3178 version of OpenOCD.
3179 @end deffn
3180
3181 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3182 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3183
3184 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3185 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3186 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3187 adapter's driver).
3188
3189 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3190 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3191 supported by the debug adapter.
3192
3193 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3194 transport, if any.
3195 @end deffn
3196
3197 @subsection JTAG Transport
3198 @cindex JTAG
3199 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3200 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3201 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3202 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3203 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3204 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3205
3206 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3207 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3208 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3209 hla_jtag}.
3210
3211 @subsection SWD Transport
3212 @cindex SWD
3213 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3214 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3215 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3216 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3217 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3218 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3219 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3220
3221 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3222 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3223 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3224 hla_swd}.
3225
3226 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3227 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3228 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3229 expected to change.
3230 @end deffn
3231 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3232 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3233 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3234 No parameters: displays current settings.
3235 @end deffn
3236
3237 @subsection SPI Transport
3238 @cindex SPI
3239 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3240 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3241 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3242 solution for flash programming.
3243
3244 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3245 @section JTAG Speed
3246 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3247 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3248 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3249 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3250 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3251 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3252 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3253 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3254 power management software that may be active.
3255
3256 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3257 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3258 target event handler.
3259 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3260 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3261 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3262 sets up those clocks).
3263 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3264 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3265 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3266 in the target config file.
3267 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3268 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3269 config file instead.
3270 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3271 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3272 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3273
3274 @example
3275 jtag_rclk 3000
3276 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3277 @end example
3278
3279 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3280 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3281 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3282 may not be the fastest solution.
3283
3284 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3285 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3286 which support adaptive clocking.
3287
3288 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3289 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3290 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3291 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3292 than the speed specified.
3293
3294 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3295 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3296 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3297 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3298
3299 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3300 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3301 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3302 JTAG clocking after setup.
3303 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3304 If the interface device can not
3305 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3306 @end deffn
3307
3308 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3309 @cindex adaptive clocking
3310 @cindex RTCK
3311 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3312 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3313 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3314 @example
3315 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3316 jtag_rclk 3000
3317 @end example
3318 @end defun
3319
3320 @node Reset Configuration
3321 @chapter Reset Configuration
3322 @cindex Reset Configuration
3323
3324 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3325 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3326 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3327 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3328 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3329 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3330 Please see the various board files for examples.
3331
3332 @quotation Note
3333 To maintainers and integrators:
3334 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3335 Normally the board configuration file
3336 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3337 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3338
3339 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3340 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3341 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3342 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3343 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3344 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3345 @end quotation
3346
3347 @section Types of Reset
3348
3349 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3350 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3351 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3352
3353 @itemize @bullet
3354 @item
3355 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3356 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3357 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3358 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3359 @item
3360 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3361 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3362 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3363 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3364 @item
3365 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3366 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3367 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3368 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3369 @item
3370 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3371 several other types of reset.
3372 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3373 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3374 There may be individual module resets.
3375 @end itemize
3376
3377 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3378 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3379 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3380 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3381 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3382 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3383 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3384 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3385 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3386
3387 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3388 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3389
3390 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3391 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3392 common issues are:
3393
3394 @itemize @bullet
3395
3396 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3397 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3398 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3399 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3400 when either of those signals is not connected.
3401 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3402 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3403 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3404 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3405
3406 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3407 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3408 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3409 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3410
3411 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3412 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3413 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3414 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3415 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3416 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3417 hardware debouncing.
3418 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3419 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3420
3421 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3422 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3423 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3424 to use push/pull output drivers.
3425 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3426 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3427 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3428 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3429
3430 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3431 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3432 issues (not limited to errata).
3433 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3434 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3435 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3436 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3437 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3438 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3439 @end itemize
3440
3441 There can also be other issues.
3442 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3443 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3444 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3445 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3446 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3447 Agreement (NDA).
3448
3449 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3450 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3451 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3452
3453 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3454 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3455
3456 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3457
3458 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3459 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3460 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3461 allowing it to be deasserted.
3462 @end deffn
3463
3464 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3465 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3466 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3467 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3468 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3469 @end deffn
3470
3471 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3472 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3473 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3474 allowing it to be deasserted.
3475 @end deffn
3476
3477 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3478 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3479 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3480 @end deffn
3481
3482 @anchor{reset_config}
3483 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3484 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3485 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3486 configuration scripts.
3487
3488 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3489 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3490 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3491 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3492 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3493 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3494 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3495 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3496
3497 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3498 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3499 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3500 -- may be specified at a time.
3501 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3502 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3503 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3504 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3505 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3506
3507 @itemize
3508 @item
3509 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3510 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3511 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3512 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3513 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3514
3515 @quotation Tip
3516 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3517 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3518 @end quotation
3519
3520 @item
3521 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3522 signal implementations.
3523 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3524 indicating everything behaves normally.
3525 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3526 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3527 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3528 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3529 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3530 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3531 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3532
3533 @item
3534 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3535 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3536 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3537 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3538 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3539 while SRST is asserted.
3540 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3541 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3542
3543 @item
3544 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3545 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3546 is required to use this option.
3547 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3548 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3549 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3550 be asserted before any target connection.
3551 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3552 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3553 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3554 @end itemize
3555
3556 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3557 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3558 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3559 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3560 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3561
3562 @itemize
3563 @item
3564 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3565 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3566 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3567 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3568
3569 @item
3570 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3571 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3572 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3573 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3574 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3575 @end itemize
3576 @end deffn
3577
3578 @section Custom Reset Handling
3579 @cindex events
3580
3581 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3582 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3583 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3584 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3585 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3586 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3587
3588 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3589 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3590 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3591 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3592 want to reset everything at once.
3593
3594 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3595 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3596 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3597 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3598 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3599 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3600 needs special attention.
3601
3602 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3603 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3604 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3605 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3606 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3607 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3608 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3609 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3610 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3611
3612 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3613 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3614 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3615 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3616 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3617
3618 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3619 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3620 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3621 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3622 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3623 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3624 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3625 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3626 or potentially some other value.
3627
3628 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3629 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3630 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3631 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3632 (or their associated targets)
3633 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3634
3635 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3636 they return.
3637 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3638 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3639 @end deffn
3640
3641 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3642 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3643 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3644 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3645 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3646 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3647 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3648 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3649 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3650 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3651 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3652 @end deffn
3653
3654 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3655 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3656 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3657 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3658 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3659 @end deffn
3660
3661
3662 @node TAP Declaration
3663 @chapter TAP Declaration
3664 @cindex TAP declaration
3665 @cindex TAP configuration
3666
3667 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3668 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3669
3670 @itemize @bullet
3671 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3672 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3673 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3674 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3675 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3676 start running that code.
3677 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3678 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3679 and missing connections.
3680 @end itemize
3681
3682 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3683 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3684 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3685 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3686 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3687
3688 @section Scan Chains
3689 @cindex scan chain
3690
3691 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3692 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3693 They also need to be added to
3694 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3695 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3696 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3697 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3698 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3699 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3700 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3701 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3702
3703 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3704 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3705 command, presented in the next chapter.
3706 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3707 debugging targets.)
3708 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3709
3710 @verbatim
3711 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3712 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3713 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3714 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3715 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3716 @end verbatim
3717
3718 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3719 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3720 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3721 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3722 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3723 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3724 until they are told to do so.
3725
3726 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3727 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3728 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3729 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3730
3731 @example
3732 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3733 @end example
3734
3735 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3736 by a given chip.
3737 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3738 and so forth.
3739 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3740 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3741 both inside a single chip and between them.
3742 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3743
3744 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3745 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3746 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3747 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3748 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3749 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3750 includes commands something like this:
3751
3752 @example
3753 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3754 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3755 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3756 @end example
3757
3758 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3759 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3760 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3761
3762 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3763 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3764 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3765 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3766 @example
3767 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3768 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3769 @}
3770 @end example
3771 @end deffn
3772
3773 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3774 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3775 and their status.
3776 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3777 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3778 but systems with a JTAG router can
3779 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3780 @end deffn
3781
3782 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3783 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3784
3785 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3786 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3787
3788 @section TAP Names
3789 @cindex dotted name
3790
3791 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3792 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3793 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3794 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3795 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3796 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3797 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3798 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3799
3800 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3801 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3802 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3803
3804 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3805
3806 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3807 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3808 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3809 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3810
3811 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3812 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3813 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3814 overridable.
3815
3816 @cindex TAP naming convention
3817 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3818 and should follow this convention:
3819
3820 @itemize @bullet
3821 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3822 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3823 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3824 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3825 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3826 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3827 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3828 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3829 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3830 with a single TAP;
3831 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3832 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3833 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3834 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3835 @end itemize
3836
3837 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3838
3839 @itemize @bullet
3840 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3841 @*The length in bits of the
3842 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3843 @end itemize
3844
3845 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3846
3847 @itemize @bullet
3848 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3849 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3850 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3851 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3852 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3853 (the TAP is linked in).
3854 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3855 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3856 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3857 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3858 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3859 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3860 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3861 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3862 values that were found but not included in the list.
3863
3864 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3865 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3866 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3867 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3868 hardware to find these values.
3869 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3870 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3871 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3872 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3873 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3874 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3875 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3876 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3877 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3878 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3879 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3880 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3881 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3882 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3883 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3884 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3885 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3886 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3887 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3888 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3889 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3890 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3891 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3892 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3893 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3894 @end itemize
3895 @end deffn
3896
3897 @section Other TAP commands
3898
3899 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
3900 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
3901 @end deffn
3902
3903 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3904 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3905 At this writing this TAP attribute
3906 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
3907 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3908 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3909 See the next section for information about the available events.
3910
3911 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3912 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3913 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3914 @end deffn
3915
3916 @section TAP Events
3917 @cindex events
3918 @cindex TAP events
3919
3920 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3921 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3922 The other applies to debugger targets,
3923 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3924
3925 The TAP events currently defined are:
3926
3927 @itemize @bullet
3928 @item @b{post-reset}
3929 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3930 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3931 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3932 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3933 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3934
3935 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3936 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3937 of any particular target.
3938 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3939 @item @b{setup}
3940 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3941 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3942 @item @b{tap-disable}
3943 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3944 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3945 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3946 @item @b{tap-enable}
3947 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3948 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3949 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3950 @end itemize
3951
3952 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3953 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3954 contents to be accurate), you might:
3955
3956 @example
3957 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3958 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3959 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3960 @}
3961 @end example
3962
3963
3964 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3965 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3966 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3967 @cindex jrc
3968
3969 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3970 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3971 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3972 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3973 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3974
3975 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3976 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3977 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3978 be visible.
3979 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3980 ignores, such as:
3981
3982 @itemize
3983 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3984 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3985 TAPs receive new instructions.
3986 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3987 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3988 @end itemize
3989
3990 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3991 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3992 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3993 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3994
3995 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3996 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3997
3998 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3999 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4000 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4001 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4002 should define TAP event handlers using
4003 code that looks something like this:
4004
4005 @example
4006 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4007 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4008 @}
4009 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4010 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4011 @}
4012 @end example
4013
4014 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4015
4016 @example
4017 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4018 @end example
4019
4020 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4021 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4022 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4023 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4024
4025 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4026 If necessary, disables the tap
4027 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4028 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4029 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4030 and "0" if it is disabled.
4031 @end deffn
4032
4033 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4034 If necessary, enables the tap
4035 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4036 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4037 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4038 and "0" if it is disabled.
4039 @end deffn
4040
4041 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4042 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4043 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4044 and "0" if it is disabled.
4045
4046 @quotation Note
4047 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4048 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4049 @end quotation
4050 @end deffn
4051
4052 @anchor{autoprobing}
4053 @section Autoprobing
4054 @cindex autoprobe
4055 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4056
4057 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4058 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4059 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4060 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4061
4062 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4063 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4064 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4065 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4066 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4067 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4068 right when they come out of reset).
4069
4070 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4071
4072 @example
4073 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4074 reset_config trst_and_srst
4075 jtag_rclk 8
4076 @end example
4077
4078 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4079 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4080
4081 @enumerate
4082 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4083 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4084 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4085 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4086 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4087 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4088 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4089 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4090 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4091 that is discovered.
4092 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4093 register, it will report it.
4094 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4095 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4096 @end enumerate
4097
4098 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4099 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4100 that's a bit more complex:
4101
4102 @example
4103 clock speed 8 kHz
4104 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4105 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4106 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4107 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4108 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4109 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4110 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4111 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4112 @end example
4113
4114 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4115 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4116 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4117 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4118 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4119 and so forth.
4120
4121 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4122 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4123 @cindex DAP declaration
4124
4125 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4126 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4127 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4128 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4129 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4130
4131 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4132
4133 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4134 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4135 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4136 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4137 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4138
4139 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4140
4141 @itemize @bullet
4142 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4143 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4144 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4145 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4146 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4147 @end itemize
4148 @end deffn
4149
4150 @deffn Command {dap names}
4151 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4152 for TCL scripting.
4153 @end deffn
4154
4155 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4156 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4157 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4158 @end deffn
4159
4160 @deffn Command {dap init}
4161 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4162 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4163 initialization, too.
4164 @end deffn
4165
4166 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4167
4168 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4169 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4170 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4171 @end deffn
4172
4173 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4174 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4175 @end deffn
4176
4177 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4178 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4179 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4180 or set a new value @var{value}.
4181 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4182 @end deffn
4183
4184 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4185 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4186 @end deffn
4187
4188 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4189 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4190 value @var{value}.
4191
4192 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4193 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4194 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4195
4196 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4197 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4198 @end deffn
4199
4200 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4201 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4202 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4203 @end deffn
4204
4205 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4206 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4207 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4208 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4209 @end deffn
4210
4211 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4212 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4213
4214 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4215 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4216 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4217 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4218 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4219 for details.
4220
4221 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4222 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4223 the pattern:
4224 @example
4225 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4226 @end example
4227
4228 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4229 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4230 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4231 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4232 @example
4233 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4234 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4235 @end example
4236
4237 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4238 @example
4239 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4240 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4241 @end example
4242
4243 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4244 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4245
4246 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4247 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4248 example with a proper dap name:
4249 @example
4250 xxx.dap apcsw default
4251 @end example
4252 @end deffn
4253
4254 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4255 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4256 Disabled by default
4257 @end deffn
4258
4259
4260 @node CPU Configuration
4261 @chapter CPU Configuration
4262 @cindex GDB target
4263
4264 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4265 You can also access these targets without GDB
4266 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4267 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4268 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4269 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4270
4271 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4272 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4273
4274 @section Target List
4275 @cindex target, current
4276 @cindex target, list
4277
4278 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4279 where each member has a name.
4280 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4281 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4282 (plural!) command.
4283 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4284 look like with more than one:
4285 @verbatim
4286 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4287 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4288 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4289 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4290 @end verbatim
4291
4292 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4293 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4294 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4295 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4296 space seen by that current target.
4297 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4298 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4299 are examples; and there are many more.
4300
4301 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4302
4303 @deffn Command {target current}
4304 Returns the name of the current target.
4305 @end deffn
4306
4307 @deffn Command {target names}
4308 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4309 @example
4310 foreach t [target names] @{
4311 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4312 @}
4313 @end example
4314 @end deffn
4315
4316 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4317 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4318
4319 @deffn Command targets [name]
4320 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4321 command names are singular.}
4322
4323 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4324 targets in a user friendly form.
4325
4326 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4327 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4328 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4329 @end deffn
4330
4331 @section Target CPU Types
4332 @cindex target type
4333 @cindex CPU type
4334
4335 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4336 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4337 when calling @command{target create}.
4338 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4339 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4340 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4341 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4342 what core-specific commands may be available
4343 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4344 and more.
4345
4346 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4347 since there's a command to list them.
4348
4349 @anchor{targettypes}
4350 @deffn Command {target types}
4351 Lists all supported target types.
4352 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4353
4354 @itemize @bullet
4355 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4356 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4357 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4358 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4359 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4360 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4361 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4362 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4363 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4364 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4365 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4366 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4367 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4368 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4369 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4370 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4371 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4372 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4373 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4374 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4375 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4376 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4377 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4378 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4379 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4380 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4381 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4382 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4383 @itemize @minus
4384 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4385 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4386 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4387 @end itemize
4388 And two debug interfaces cores:
4389 @itemize @minus
4390 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4391 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4392 @end itemize
4393 @end itemize
4394 @end deffn
4395
4396 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4397 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4398 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4399 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4400 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4401 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4402 reflect design generations;
4403 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4404 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4405
4406 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4407 @section Target Configuration
4408
4409 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4410 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4411 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4412 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4413 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4414
4415 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4416 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4417 optional parts.
4418 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4419 command, created as part of target creation.
4420
4421 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4422 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4423 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4424 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4425 to be much more board-specific.
4426 The key steps you use might look something like this
4427
4428 @example
4429 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4430 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4431 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4432 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4433 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4434 @end example
4435
4436 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4437 on-chip SRAM.
4438 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4439 writes to target memory;
4440 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4441 GDB memory checksumming;
4442 and more.
4443
4444 @quotation Warning
4445 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4446 inaccessible when application code
4447 (such as an operating system)
4448 enables or disables the MMU.
4449 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4450 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4451 easy access to other addresses needed.
4452 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4453 @end quotation
4454
4455 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4456 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4457 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4458 controllers.
4459 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4460 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4461 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4462
4463 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4464 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4465 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4466 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4467 purposes including additional configuration.
4468
4469 @itemize @bullet
4470 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4471 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4472 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4473 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4474
4475 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4476 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4477 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4478 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4479 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4480 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4481 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4482
4483 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4484 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4485 @end itemize
4486 @end deffn
4487
4488 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4489 The options accepted by this command may also be
4490 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4491 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4492 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4493
4494 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4495 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4496 and changing its endianness.
4497
4498 @itemize @bullet
4499
4500 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4501 used to access this target.
4502
4503 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4504 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4505 create and manage DAP instances.
4506
4507 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4508 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4509
4510 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4511 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4512 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4513 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4514 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4515 same event name assigns only one handler.
4516
4517 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4518 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4519
4520 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4521 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4522 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4523 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4524 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4525 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4526 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4527
4528 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4529 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4530 or virtual address is being used.
4531
4532 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4533 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4534
4535 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4536 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4537 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4538 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4539 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4540
4541 @anchor{rtostype}
4542 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4543 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4544 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4545 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4546 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4547
4548 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4549 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4550 access the target for debugging.
4551
4552 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4553 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4554 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4555 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4556
4557 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4558 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4559 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4560 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4561 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4562
4563 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4564 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4565 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4566 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4567 command @command{gdb_port}.
4568 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4569 @end itemize
4570 @end deffn
4571
4572 @section Other $target_name Commands
4573 @cindex object command
4574
4575 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4576 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4577
4578 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4579 Once a button is created a button
4580 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4581 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4582 configure it like this:
4583
4584 @example
4585 # Create
4586 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4587 # Modify
4588 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4589 # Query
4590 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4591 # Report
4592 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4593 @end example
4594
4595 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4596 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4597
4598 @example
4599 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4600 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4601 @end example
4602
4603 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4604
4605 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4606 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4607 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4608 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4609 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4610 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4611 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4612 They are not otherwise documented here.
4613 @end deffn
4614
4615 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4616 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4617 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4618 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4619 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4620 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4621 the target side uses raw memory.
4622
4623 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4624 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4625 The script orientation comes from working with data
4626 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4627 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4628 and neither store nor return those values.
4629
4630 @itemize
4631 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4632 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4633 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4634 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4635 @end itemize
4636 @end deffn
4637
4638 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4639 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4640 @command{$target_name configure}
4641 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4642 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4643 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4644 There are a few special cases:
4645
4646 @itemize @bullet
4647 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4648 event named @var{event_name}.
4649 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4650 two parameters.
4651 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4652 This is a special case because this is set using
4653 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4654 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4655 @end itemize
4656
4657 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4658 all the targets you might use something like this:
4659
4660 @example
4661 foreach name [target names] @{
4662 set y [$name cget -endian]
4663 set z [$name cget -type]
4664 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4665 $x $name $y $z]
4666 @}
4667 @end example
4668 @end deffn
4669
4670 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4671 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4672 Displays the current target state:
4673 @code{debug-running},
4674 @code{halted},
4675 @code{reset},
4676 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4677 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4678 @end deffn
4679
4680 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4681 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4682 currently associated with this target.
4683 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4684 @end deffn
4685
4686 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4687 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4688 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4689 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4690 @end deffn
4691
4692 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4693 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4694 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4695 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4696 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4697 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4698 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4699 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4700 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4701 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4702 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4703 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4704 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4705 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4706 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4707 @end deffn
4708
4709 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4710 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4711 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4712 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4713 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4714 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4715 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4716 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4717 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4718 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4719 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4720 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4721 @end deffn
4722
4723 @anchor{targetevents}
4724 @section Target Events
4725 @cindex target events
4726 @cindex events
4727 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4728 For example:
4729 @itemize @bullet
4730 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4731 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4732 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4733 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4734 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4735 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4736 to set up system clocks or
4737 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4738 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4739 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4740 @end itemize
4741
4742 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4743 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4744 @command{target create ... -event}.
4745
4746 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4747 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4748 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4749
4750 @example
4751 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4752 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4753 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4754 @}
4755 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4756 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4757 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4758 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4759 @}
4760 @end example
4761
4762 The following target events are defined:
4763
4764 @itemize @bullet
4765 @item @b{debug-halted}
4766 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4767 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4768 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4769 @item @b{early-halted}
4770 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4771 @item @b{examine-start}
4772 @* Before target examine is called.
4773 @item @b{examine-end}
4774 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4775 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4776 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4777 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4778 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4779 connect GDB to running target.
4780 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4781 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4782 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4783 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4784 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4785 is in RAM or read only memory.
4786 Default is @code{halt}
4787 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4788 @* When GDB disconnects
4789 @item @b{gdb-end}
4790 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4791 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4792 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4793 @code{reset init})
4794 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4795 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4796 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4797 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4798 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4799 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4800 @item @b{gdb-start}
4801 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4802 @item @b{halted}
4803 @* The target has halted
4804 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4805 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4806 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4807 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4808 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4809 @item @b{reset-assert}
4810 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4811 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4812 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4813 it instead of asserting SRST.
4814 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4815 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4816 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4817 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4818 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4819 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4820 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4821 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4822 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4823 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4824 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4825 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4826 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4827 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4828 released on the scan chain.
4829 @item @b{reset-end}
4830 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4831 @item @b{reset-init}
4832 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4833 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4834
4835 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4836 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4837 multiplexing, and so on.
4838 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4839 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4840 @item @b{reset-start}
4841 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4842 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4843
4844 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4845 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4846 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4847 @item @b{resume-start}
4848 @* Before any target is resumed
4849 @item @b{resume-end}
4850 @* After all targets have resumed
4851 @item @b{resumed}
4852 @* Target has resumed
4853 @item @b{trace-config}
4854 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4855 @end itemize
4856
4857 @node Flash Commands
4858 @chapter Flash Commands
4859
4860 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4861 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4862 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4863 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4864 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4865 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4866 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4867 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4868 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4869
4870 Flash Steps:
4871 @enumerate
4872 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4873 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4874 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4875 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4876 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4877 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4878 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4879 @item GDB Flashing
4880 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4881 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4882 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4883 @end enumerate
4884
4885 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4886 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4887 so that it can't boot.
4888 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4889 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4890
4891 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4892 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4893 @cindex flash configuration
4894
4895 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4896 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4897 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4898 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4899 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4900 see the driver-specific documentation.
4901
4902 @itemize @bullet
4903 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4904 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4905 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4906 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4907 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4908 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4909 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4910 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4911 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4912 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4913 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4914 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4915 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4916 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4917 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4918 commands to the flash controller.
4919 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4920 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4921 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4922 for more information.
4923 @end itemize
4924 @quotation Note
4925 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4926 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4927 @end quotation
4928 @end deffn
4929
4930 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4931 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4932 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4933 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4934 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4935 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4936 @end deffn
4937
4938 @deffn Command {flash list}
4939 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4940 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4941 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4942 @end deffn
4943
4944 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4945 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4946 depends on the flash type.
4947 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4948 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4949 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4950 but most don't bother.
4951 @end deffn
4952
4953 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
4954
4955 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
4956 begins.
4957
4958 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
4959 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
4960 until the programming session is finished.
4961
4962 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
4963 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
4964
4965 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
4966
4967 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4968 @cindex flash erasing
4969 @cindex flash reading
4970 @cindex flash writing
4971 @cindex flash programming
4972 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4973
4974 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4975 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
4976 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4977 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4978 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4979
4980 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4981 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4982 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4983 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4984 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4985
4986 @quotation Note
4987 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4988 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4989 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4990 back to a flash bank.
4991 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4992 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4993 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4994 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4995 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4996 @end quotation
4997
4998 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4999 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5000 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5001 disabled first.
5002 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5003 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5004 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5005
5006 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5007 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5008 up to and including @var{last}.
5009 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5010 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5011 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5012 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5013 @end deffn
5014
5015 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5016 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5017 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5018 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5019 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5020 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5021 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5022 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5023 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5024 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5025 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5026 before erase starts.
5027 @end deffn
5028
5029 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
5030 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5031 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5032 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
5033 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5034 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5035 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5036 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5037 before issuing this command.
5038 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5039 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5040 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5041 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5042 @end deffn
5043 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5044
5045 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5046 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5047 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5048 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5049 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5050 @end deffn
5051
5052 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5053 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5054 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5055 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5056 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5057 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5058 @end deffn
5059
5060 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5061 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5062 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5063 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5064 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5065 @end deffn
5066
5067 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5068 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5069 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5070 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5071 to the base address for each section in the image.
5072 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5073 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5074 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5075 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5076 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5077 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5078 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5079 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5080 each image section.
5081
5082 @quotation Warning
5083 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5084 data you want to preserve.
5085 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5086 sections might be erased with no notice.
5087 @itemize
5088 @item
5089 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5090 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5091 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5092 @item
5093 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5094 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5095 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5096 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5097 @end itemize
5098 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5099 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5100 @end quotation
5101
5102 @end deffn
5103
5104 @section Other Flash commands
5105 @cindex flash protection
5106
5107 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5108 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5109 and display that status.
5110 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5111 @end deffn
5112
5113 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5114 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5115 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5116
5117 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5118 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5119 and possibly stale information.
5120 @end deffn
5121
5122 @anchor{flashprotect}
5123 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5124 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5125 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5126 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5127 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5128 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5129 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5130 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5131 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5132 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5133 @end deffn
5134
5135 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5136 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5137 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5138 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5139 @end deffn
5140
5141 @anchor{program}
5142 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5143 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5144 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5145 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5146 @end deffn
5147
5148 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5149 @section Flash Driver List
5150 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5151 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5152 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5153
5154 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5155 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5156 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5157
5158 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5159
5160 @itemize
5161 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5162 @end itemize
5163
5164 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5165 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5166 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5167 @example
5168 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5169 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5170 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5171 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5172 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5173 @end example
5174 @end deffn
5175
5176 @subsection External Flash
5177
5178 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5179 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5180 @cindex CFI
5181 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5182 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5183 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5184 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5185 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5186 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5187 configure a bus and its timings), or
5188 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5189 on the flash chip.
5190 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5191 speed up operation.
5192
5193 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5194
5195 @itemize
5196 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5197 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5198 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5199 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5200 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5201 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5202 @end itemize
5203
5204 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5205 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5206
5207 @example
5208 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5209 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5210 @end example
5211
5212 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5213 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5214 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5215
5216 @example
5217 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5218 @end example
5219
5220 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5221 @end deffn
5222
5223 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5224 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5225 @cindex SPI
5226 @cindex jtagspi
5227 @cindex bscan_spi
5228 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5229 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5230 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5231 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5232 accessed through JTAG.
5233
5234 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5235 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5236 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5237 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5238 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5239 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5240
5241 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5242 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5243 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5244 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5245 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5246 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5247 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5248 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5249
5250 @itemize
5251 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5252 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5253 @var{USER1} instruction.
5254 @end itemize
5255
5256 @example
5257 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5258 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5259 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5260 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5261 @end example
5262 @end deffn
5263
5264 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5265 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5266 @cindex xcf
5267 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5268 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5269 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5270 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5271 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5272
5273 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5274 command accepts additional parameters:
5275 @itemize
5276 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5277 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5278 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5279 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5280 in master mode.
5281 @end itemize
5282 @example
5283 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5284 @end example
5285 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5286 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5287 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5288 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5289 dedicated sector.
5290 @end deffn
5291
5292 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5293 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5294 button.
5295 @example
5296 xcf configure 0
5297 @end example
5298 @end deffn
5299
5300 Additional driver notes:
5301 @itemize
5302 @item Only single revision supported.
5303 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5304 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5305 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5306 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5307 @end itemize
5308 @end deffn
5309
5310 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5311 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5312 @cindex SPIFI
5313 @cindex lpcspifi
5314 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5315 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5316 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5317
5318 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5319 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5320 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5321 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5322 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5323
5324 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5325 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5326 are configured by the driver.
5327
5328 @example
5329 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5330 @end example
5331
5332 @end deffn
5333
5334 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5335 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5336 @cindex SMI
5337 @cindex stmsmi
5338 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5339 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5340 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5341 SPI flash devices.
5342 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5343 flash devices can be connected.
5344
5345 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5346 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5347 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5348 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5349 the flash content.
5350
5351 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5352 to identify the memory bank.
5353 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5354 flash size, are detected automatically.
5355
5356 @example
5357 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5358 @end example
5359
5360 @end deffn
5361
5362 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5363 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5364 Microcontroller platform.
5365
5366 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5367 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5368
5369 @example
5370 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5371 @end example
5372
5373 @end deffn
5374
5375 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5376 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5377 @cindex ath79
5378 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5379 chip selects.
5380 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5381 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5382 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5383 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5384 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5385 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5386
5387 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5388 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5389 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5390 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5391 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5392 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5393 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5394 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5395 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5396 with the default CS0.
5397 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5398 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5399 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5400
5401 @example
5402 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5403
5404 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5405 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5406 # banks.
5407 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5408 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5409 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5410 @end example
5411
5412 @end deffn
5413
5414 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5415 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5416 @cindex fespi
5417
5418 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5419
5420 @example
5421 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5422 @end example
5423 @end deffn
5424
5425 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5426
5427 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5428 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5429 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5430 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5431 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5432 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5433
5434 @example
5435 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5436 @end example
5437 @end deffn
5438
5439 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5440 @cindex ambiqmicro
5441 @cindex apollo
5442 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5443 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5444 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5445 with the target using SWD.
5446
5447 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5448 the device class of the MCU.
5449 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5450 to set up the flash banks.
5451 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5452 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5453
5454 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5455 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5456 and the second bank starts after the first.
5457
5458 @example
5459 # Flash bank 0
5460 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5461 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5462 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5463 $_TARGETNAME
5464 @end example
5465
5466 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5467 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5468 are available to the user.
5469
5470 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5471
5472 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5473 Erase entire bank.
5474 @end deffn
5475 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5476 Erase device pages.
5477 @end deffn
5478 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5479 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5480 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5481 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5482 the flash.
5483 @end deffn
5484 @end deffn
5485
5486 @anchor{at91samd}
5487 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5488 @cindex at91samd
5489 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5490 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5491
5492 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5493
5494 The devices have one flash bank:
5495
5496 @example
5497 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5498 @end example
5499
5500 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5501 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5502 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5503 processor to be halted.
5504 @end deffn
5505
5506 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5507 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5508 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5509 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5510 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5511 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5512
5513 @example
5514 at91samd set-security enable
5515 @end example
5516 @end deffn
5517
5518 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5519 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5520 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5521 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5522 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5523 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5524 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5525 in order to disable this feature.
5526
5527 @example
5528 at91samd eeprom
5529 at91samd eeprom 1024
5530 @end example
5531 @end deffn
5532
5533 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5534 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5535 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5536 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5537 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5538 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5539
5540 @example
5541 at91samd bootloader
5542 at91samd bootloader 16384
5543 @end example
5544 @end deffn
5545
5546 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5547 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5548 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5549 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5550 @end deffn
5551
5552 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5553 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5554 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5555 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5556 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5557 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5558 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5559 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5560
5561 @example
5562 # Read user row
5563 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5564 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5565 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5566 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5567 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5568 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5569 @end example
5570 @end deffn
5571
5572 @end deffn
5573
5574 @anchor{at91sam3}
5575 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5576 @cindex at91sam3
5577 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5578 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5579 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5580 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5581 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5582 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5583 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5584 chips are confirmed.}
5585
5586 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5587 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5588 the following fixed locations:
5589
5590 @example
5591 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5592 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5593 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5594 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5595 @end example
5596
5597 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5598 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5599 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5600
5601 @itemize
5602 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5603 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5604 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5605 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5606 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5607 @end itemize
5608
5609 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5610
5611 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5612 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5613 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5614 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5615 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5616 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5617 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5618
5619 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5620 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5621 @end deffn
5622
5623 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5624 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5625 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5626 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5627 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5628 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5629 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5630 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5631 @end deffn
5632
5633 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5634 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5635 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5636 @end deffn
5637 @end deffn
5638
5639 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5640 @cindex at91sam4
5641 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5642 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5643 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5644 @end deffn
5645
5646 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5647 @cindex at91sam4l
5648 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5649 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5650 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5651
5652 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5653 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5654 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5655 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5656 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5657 @end deffn
5658 @end deffn
5659
5660 @anchor{atsame5}
5661 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5662 @cindex atsame5
5663 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5664 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5665 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5666
5667 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5668 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5669 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5670
5671 @example
5672 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5673 @end example
5674
5675 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5676 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5677 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5678 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5679 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5680 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5681
5682 @example
5683 atsame5 bootloader
5684 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5685 @end example
5686 @end deffn
5687
5688 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5689 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5690 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5691 processor to be halted.
5692 @end deffn
5693
5694 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5695 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5696 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5697 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5698 @end deffn
5699
5700 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5701 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5702 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5703 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5704 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5705 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5706 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5707 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5708
5709 @example
5710 # Read
5711 >atsame5 userpage
5712 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5713 # Write
5714 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5715 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5716 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5717 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5718 @end example
5719 @end deffn
5720
5721 @end deffn
5722
5723 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5724 @cindex atsamv
5725 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5726 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5727 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5728 @end deffn
5729
5730 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5731 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5732 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5733 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5734 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5735
5736 @example
5737 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5738 @end example
5739
5740 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5741 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5742
5743 @itemize
5744 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5745 @item @var{banks}
5746 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5747 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5748 @item @var{pages_size}
5749 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5750 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5751 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5752 @end itemize
5753
5754 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5755 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5756 will be autoconfigured.
5757 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5758
5759 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5760 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5761 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5762 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5763 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5764
5765 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5766 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5767 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5768 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5769 are not truly general purpose).
5770 @quotation Note
5771 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5772 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5773 @end quotation
5774 @end deffn
5775 @end deffn
5776
5777 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5778 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5779 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5780 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5781 @end deffn
5782
5783 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5784 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5785 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5786 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5787
5788 @example
5789 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5790 @end example
5791
5792 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5793 each single sector one by one.
5794
5795 @example
5796 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5797 @end example
5798
5799 @example
5800 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5801 @end example
5802
5803 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5804 @end deffn
5805
5806 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5807 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5808 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5809 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5810 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5811 starts at address 0.
5812
5813 @example
5814 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5815 @end example
5816 @end deffn
5817
5818 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5819 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5820 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5821 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5822 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5823 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5824 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5825 and programming the serial flash.
5826
5827 @example
5828 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5829 @end example
5830 @end deffn
5831
5832 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5833 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5834 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5835 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5836 autoconfigures itself.
5837 @example
5838 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5839 @end example
5840 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5841 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5842 this via the following command:
5843 @example
5844 efm32 debuglock num
5845 @end example
5846 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5847 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5848 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5849 supported.}
5850 @end deffn
5851
5852 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5853 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5854 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5855 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5856 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5857 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5858
5859 @example
5860 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5861 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5862 @end example
5863
5864 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5865 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5866 @end deffn
5867
5868 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5869 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5870 is an uncommon operation.}
5871 @end deffn
5872 @end deffn
5873
5874 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5875 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5876 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5877 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5878 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5879 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5880 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5881
5882 @example
5883 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5884 @end example
5885 @end deffn
5886
5887 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5888 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5889 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5890 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5891 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5892 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5893 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5894 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5895 characters) ignored.
5896
5897 @example
5898 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5899 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5900 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5901 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5902 @end example
5903 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5904 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5905 @end deffn
5906
5907 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5908 @cindex kinetis
5909 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5910 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5911 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5912 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5913 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5914 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5915
5916 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5917 @itemize
5918 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5919 @end itemize
5920
5921 @example
5922 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5923 @end example
5924
5925 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5926 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5927 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5928 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5929 @end deffn
5930
5931 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5932 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5933 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5934 set by 'flash protect' command.
5935 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5936 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5937 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5938 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5939 with the rest of a flash image.
5940 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5941 @end deffn
5942
5943 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5944 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5945 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5946 @end deffn
5947
5948 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5949 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5950 @end deffn
5951
5952 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5953 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5954 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5955 @end deffn
5956
5957 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5958 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5959 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5960 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5961 command completes.
5962 @end deffn
5963
5964 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5965 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5966 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5967 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5968 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5969
5970 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5971 Program Partition command.
5972
5973 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5974 Reset the device after partition setting.
5975
5976 Show partition size:
5977 @example
5978 kinetis nvm_partition info
5979 @end example
5980
5981 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5982 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5983 @example
5984 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5985 @end example
5986
5987 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5988 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5989 @example
5990 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5991 @end example
5992 @end deffn
5993
5994 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5995 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5996 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5997 @end deffn
5998
5999 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6000 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6001 Command disables watchdog timer.
6002 @end deffn
6003 @end deffn
6004
6005 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6006 @cindex kinetis_ke
6007 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6008 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6009 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6010 autoconfigures itself.
6011 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6012
6013 @example
6014 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6015 @end example
6016
6017 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6018 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6019 @end deffn
6020
6021 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6022 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6023 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6024 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6025 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6026 @end deffn
6027
6028 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6029 Command disables watchdog timer.
6030 @end deffn
6031 @end deffn
6032
6033 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6034 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6035 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6036 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6037 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6038
6039 @quotation Note
6040 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6041 driver:
6042 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6043 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6044 @end quotation
6045
6046 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6047 which must appear in the following order:
6048
6049 @itemize
6050 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6051 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6052 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6053 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6054 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6055 LPC43x[2357])
6056 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6057 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6058 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6059 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6060 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6061 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6062 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6063 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6064 at which the core is running
6065 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6066 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6067 @quotation Note
6068 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6069 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6070 However, if you do provide it,
6071 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6072 @end quotation
6073 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6074 ROM IAP entry point.
6075 @end itemize
6076
6077 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6078
6079 @example
6080 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6081 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6082 @end example
6083
6084 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6085 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6086 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6087 @end deffn
6088 @end deffn
6089
6090 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6091 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6092 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6093 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6094 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6095 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6096
6097 @example
6098 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6099 @end example
6100 @end deffn
6101
6102 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6103 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6104 from NXP.
6105
6106 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6107 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6108 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6109 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6110 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6111 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6112 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6113 you start the PLL.
6114
6115 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6116
6117 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6118 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6119 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6120
6121 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6122 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6123 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6124 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6125 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6126 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6127 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6128
6129 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6130 @example
6131 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6132 @end example
6133
6134 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6135 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6136 @code{flash banks} command.
6137
6138 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6139 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6140 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6141 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6142 a known signature.
6143 Example:
6144 @example
6145 lpc2900 signature 0
6146 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6147 @end example
6148 @end deffn
6149
6150 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6151 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6152 saves it to a file in binary format.
6153 Example:
6154 @example
6155 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6156 @end example
6157 @end deffn
6158
6159 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6160 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6161 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6162 command:
6163
6164 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6165 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6166 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6167 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6168
6169 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6170 Example:
6171 @example
6172 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6173 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6174 @end example
6175 @end deffn
6176
6177 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6178 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6179 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6180 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6181 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6182 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6183 912 bytes.
6184 @quotation Attention
6185 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6186 @end quotation
6187 Example:
6188 @example
6189 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6190 @end example
6191 @end deffn
6192
6193 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6194 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6195 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6196 after the next power cycle.
6197 @quotation Attention
6198 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6199 @end quotation
6200 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6201 Example:
6202 @example
6203 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6204 flash info 0
6205 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6206 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6207 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6208 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6209 @end example
6210 @end deffn
6211
6212 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6213 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6214 effective after the next power cycle.
6215 @quotation Attention
6216 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6217 @end quotation
6218 Examples:
6219 @example
6220 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6221 @end example
6222 @end deffn
6223 @end deffn
6224
6225 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6226 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6227 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6228 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6229
6230 @example
6231 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6232 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6233 @end example
6234
6235 @itemize @bullet
6236 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6237 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6238 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6239 @end itemize
6240
6241 Example usage:
6242 @example
6243 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6244 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6245 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6246 @} else @{
6247 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6248 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6249 @}
6250 @end example
6251 @end deffn
6252
6253 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6254 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6255 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6256 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6257 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6258 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6259
6260 @example
6261 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6262 @end example
6263
6264 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6265 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6266 only the main program flash.
6267
6268 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6269 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6270 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6271 @end deffn
6272
6273 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6274 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6275 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6276 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6277
6278 To erase and program the BSL:
6279 @example
6280 msp432 bsl unlock
6281 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6282 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6283 msp432 bsl lock
6284 @end example
6285 @end deffn
6286 @end deffn
6287
6288 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6289 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6290 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6291 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6292 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6293 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6294 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6295 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6296 also have division into regions: main and info.
6297 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6298 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6299
6300 @example
6301 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6302 @end example
6303
6304 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6305
6306 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6307 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6308 @end deffn
6309
6310 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6311 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6312 @end deffn
6313
6314 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6315 Erase all userflash including info region.
6316 @end deffn
6317
6318 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6319 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6320 @end deffn
6321
6322 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6323 Check sectors protect.
6324 @end deffn
6325
6326 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6327 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6328 @end deffn
6329
6330 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6331 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6332 @end deffn
6333
6334 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6335 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6336 @end deffn
6337
6338 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6339 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6340 @end deffn
6341
6342 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6343 Show information about flash driver.
6344 @end deffn
6345
6346 @end deffn
6347
6348 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6349 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6350 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6351 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6352 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6353
6354 @example
6355 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6356 @end example
6357
6358 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6359
6360 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6361 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6362 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6363 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6364 code.
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6368 Decodes and shows informations from FICR and UICR registers.
6369 @end deffn
6370
6371 @end deffn
6372
6373 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6374 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6375 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6376
6377 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6378 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6379 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6380 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6381
6382 @example
6383 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6384 @end example
6385 @end deffn
6386
6387 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6388 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6389 and integrate flash memory.
6390
6391 @example
6392 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6393 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6394 @end example
6395
6396 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6397 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6398 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6399 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6400 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6401 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6402 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6403 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6404 @end deffn
6405 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6406 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6407 This will remove any Code Protection.
6408 @end deffn
6409 @end deffn
6410
6411 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6412 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6413 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6414 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6415 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6416
6417 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6418 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6419
6420 @example
6421 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6422 @end example
6423
6424 psoc4-specific commands
6425 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6426 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6427
6428 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6429 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6430
6431 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6432 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6433 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6434
6435 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6436 @end deffn
6437
6438 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6439 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6440
6441 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6442 @end deffn
6443 @end deffn
6444
6445 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6446 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6447 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6448 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6449 apart from the base address.
6450
6451 @example
6452 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6453 @end example
6454
6455 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6456 @quotation Attention
6457 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6458 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6459 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6460 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6461 @end quotation
6462
6463 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6464
6465 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6466 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6467 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6468 @end deffn
6469 @end deffn
6470
6471 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6472 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6473 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6474 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6475 apart from the base address.
6476
6477 @example
6478 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6479 @end example
6480 @end deffn
6481
6482 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6483 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6484 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6485 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6486
6487 @example
6488 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6489 @end example
6490
6491 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6492
6493 @itemize
6494 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6495 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6496 @end itemize
6497
6498 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6499
6500 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6501 @quotation Attention
6502 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6503 after successful write.
6504 @end quotation
6505 @end deffn
6506
6507 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6508 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6509 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6510 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6511
6512 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6513 @itemize @bullet
6514 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6515 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6516 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6517 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6518 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6519 row size: 512 bytes.
6520 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6521 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6522 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6523 operation will erase row automatically.
6524 @end itemize
6525
6526 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6527 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6528
6529 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6530
6531 @example
6532 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6533 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6534 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6535 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6536 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6537 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6538
6539 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6540 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6541 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6542 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6543 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6544 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6545 @end example
6546
6547 psoc6-specific commands
6548 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6549 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6550 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6551 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6552 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6553 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6554 @end deffn
6555
6556 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6557 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6558 by @command{flash banks}.
6559 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6560 @end deffn
6561 @end deffn
6562
6563 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6564 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6565 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6566 and SWD interface.
6567 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6568 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6569
6570 @example
6571 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6572 @end example
6573
6574 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6575
6576 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6577 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6578 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6579 @end deffn
6580
6581 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6582 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6583 @end deffn
6584 @end deffn
6585
6586 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6587 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6588 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6589 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6590 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6591
6592 @example
6593 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6594 @end example
6595
6596 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6597 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6598 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6599 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6600 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6601 disabled.
6602
6603 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6604 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6605 @quotation Warning
6606 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6607 applied to all of them.
6608 @end quotation
6609 @end deffn
6610 @end deffn
6611
6612 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6613 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6614 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6615 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6616 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6617
6618 @example
6619 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6620 @end example
6621
6622 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6623 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6624 the flash driver.
6625
6626 @example
6627 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6628 @end example
6629
6630 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6631 as per the following example.
6632 @example
6633 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6634 @end example
6635
6636 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6637
6638 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6639 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6640 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6641 @end deffn
6642
6643 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6644 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6645 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6646 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6647 @end deffn
6648
6649 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6650 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6651 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6652 @end deffn
6653
6654 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6655 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6656 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6657 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6658 @end deffn
6659
6660 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6661 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6662 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6663 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6664 @end deffn
6665
6666 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6667 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6668 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6669 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6670 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6671 @end deffn
6672 @end deffn
6673
6674 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6675 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6676 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6677 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6678 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6679
6680 @example
6681 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6682 @end example
6683
6684 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6685 as per the following example.
6686 @example
6687 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6688 @end example
6689
6690 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6691 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6692 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6693 @end deffn
6694
6695 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6696 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6697 the flash driver.
6698
6699 @example
6700 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6701 @end example
6702
6703 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6704
6705 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6706 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6707 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6708 @end deffn
6709
6710 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6711 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6712 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6713 @end deffn
6714
6715 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6716 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6717 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6718 @end deffn
6719
6720 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6721 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6722 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6723 @end deffn
6724
6725 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6726 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6727 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6728 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6729 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6730 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6731 @end deffn
6732
6733 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6734 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6735 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6736 @end deffn
6737 @end deffn
6738
6739 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6740 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6741 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6742 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6743 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6744
6745 @example
6746 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6747 @end example
6748
6749 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6750 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6751 the flash driver.
6752
6753 @example
6754 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6755 @end example
6756
6757 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6758
6759 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6760 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6761 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6762 @end deffn
6763
6764 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6765 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6766 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6767 @end deffn
6768
6769 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6770 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6771 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6772 @end deffn
6773
6774 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6775 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6776 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6777 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6778 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6779
6780 Example usage:
6781 @example
6782 # read OPTSR_CUR
6783 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6784 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6785 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6786 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6787 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6788 @end example
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6792 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6793 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6794 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6795 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6796 will be touched).
6797
6798 Example usage:
6799 @example
6800 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6801 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6802 @end example
6803 @end deffn
6804 @end deffn
6805
6806 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6807 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6808 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6809 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6810 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6811
6812 @example
6813 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6814 @end example
6815
6816 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6817 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6818 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6819 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6820 second bank.
6821
6822 @example
6823 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6824 @end example
6825
6826 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6827
6828 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6829 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6830 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6831 @end deffn
6832
6833 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6834 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6835 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6836 @end deffn
6837
6838 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6839 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6840 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6841 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6842 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6843 @end deffn
6844 @end deffn
6845
6846 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6847 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6848 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6849 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6850 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6851
6852 @example
6853 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6854 @end example
6855
6856 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6857 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6858 the flash driver.
6859
6860 @example
6861 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6862 @end example
6863
6864 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6865
6866 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6867 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6868 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6869 @end deffn
6870
6871 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6872 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6873 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6874 @end deffn
6875
6876 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6877 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6878 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6879 @end deffn
6880
6881 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6882 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6883 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6884 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6885
6886 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6887 @example
6888 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6889 # Option Register: <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6890 @end example
6891
6892 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6893 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6894 @end deffn
6895
6896 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6897 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6898 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6899 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6900 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6901
6902 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6903 @example
6904 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6905 @end example
6906
6907 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6908 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6909 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6910 @end deffn
6911
6912 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6913 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6914 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6915 @end deffn
6916 @end deffn
6917
6918 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6919 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6920 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6921 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6922 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6923
6924 @example
6925 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6926 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6927 @end example
6928
6929 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6930 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6931 for the specified flash bank.
6932 @end deffn
6933 @end deffn
6934
6935 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6936 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6937 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6938 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6939 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6940
6941 @example
6942 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6943 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6944 @end example
6945
6946 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6947 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6948 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6949
6950 @itemize @bullet
6951 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6952 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6953 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6954 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6955 @end itemize
6956 @end deffn
6957
6958 @end deffn
6959
6960 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6961 @cindex str9xpec
6962
6963 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6964 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6965 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6966 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6967
6968 Here is some background info to help
6969 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6970 the str9:
6971 @enumerate
6972 @item
6973 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6974 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6975 @item
6976 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6977 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6978 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6979 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6980 @end enumerate
6981
6982 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6983 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6984 configured for flash bank 0.
6985 @example
6986 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6987 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6988 adapter assert srst
6989 # turn off target polling
6990 poll off
6991 # disable str9 core
6992 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6993 # read option bytes
6994 str9xpec options_read 0
6995 # re-enable str9 core
6996 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6997 poll on
6998 reset halt
6999 @end example
7000 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7001 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7002 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7003 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7004
7005 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7006
7007 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7008 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7009 @end deffn
7010
7011 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7012 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7013 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7017 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7018 erase the device.
7019 @end deffn
7020
7021 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7022 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7023 @end deffn
7024
7025 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7026 Configure str9 boot bank.
7027 @end deffn
7028
7029 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7030 Configure str9 lvd source.
7031 @end deffn
7032
7033 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7034 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7035 @end deffn
7036
7037 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7038 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7039 @end deffn
7040
7041 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7042 Read str9 option bytes.
7043 @end deffn
7044
7045 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7046 Write str9 option bytes.
7047 @end deffn
7048
7049 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7050 unlock str9 device.
7051 @end deffn
7052
7053 @end deffn
7054
7055 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7056 @cindex swm050
7057 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7058
7059 @example
7060 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7061 @end example
7062
7063 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7064
7065 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7066 Erases the entire flash bank.
7067 @end deffn
7068
7069 @end deffn
7070
7071
7072 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7073 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7074 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7075 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7076
7077 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7078
7079 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7080 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7081 @end deffn
7082
7083 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7084 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7085 @end deffn
7086
7087 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7088 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7089 the flash clock.
7090 @end deffn
7091 @end deffn
7092
7093 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7094 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7095 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7096 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7097 correct bank config.
7098
7099 @example
7100 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7101 @end example
7102 @end deffn
7103
7104 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7105 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7106 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7107 @end deffn
7108
7109 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7110 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7111 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7112
7113 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7114
7115 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7116 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7117 @end deffn
7118
7119 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7120 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7121 @end deffn
7122
7123 @end deffn
7124
7125 @section NAND Flash Commands
7126 @cindex NAND
7127
7128 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7129 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7130 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7131
7132 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7133 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7134 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7135 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7136 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7137 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7138
7139 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7140 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7141 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7142 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7143 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7144 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7145 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7146 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7147 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7148 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7149
7150 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7151 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7152 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7153 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7154 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7155 every 512 bytes of data.
7156
7157 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7158 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7159 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7160 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7161 ECC mode is used.
7162
7163 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7164 @enumerate
7165 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7166 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7167 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7168 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7169 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7170 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7171 to access that device.
7172 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7173 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7174 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7175 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7176 de-brick a board.
7177 @end enumerate
7178
7179 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7180 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7181 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7182 are only 32 bits wide.
7183 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7184 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7185 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7186 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7187
7188 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7189 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7190 @cindex NAND configuration
7191
7192 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7193 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7194 OpenOCD has initialized.
7195
7196 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7197 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7198 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7199 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7200 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7201 they were a single (larger) device.
7202 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7203 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7204
7205 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7206 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7207 configuration files, not interactively.
7208
7209 @itemize @bullet
7210 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7211 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7212 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7213 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7214 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7215 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7216 commands to the NAND controller.
7217 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7218 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7219 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7220 for more information.
7221 @end itemize
7222 @end deffn
7223
7224 @deffn Command {nand list}
7225 Prints a summary of each device declared
7226 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7227 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7228 @example
7229 > nand list
7230 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7231 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7232 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7233 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7234 >
7235 @end example
7236 @end deffn
7237
7238 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7239 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7240 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7241 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7242 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7243 it with most other NAND commands.
7244 @end deffn
7245
7246 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7247
7248 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7249 @cindex NAND reading
7250 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7251 starting at the specified offset.
7252 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7253
7254 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7255 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7256
7257 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7258 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7259 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7260
7261 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7262 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7263 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7264 method which handled that error correction.
7265
7266 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7267 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7268 @itemize @bullet
7269 @item no oob_* parameter
7270 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7271 @item @code{oob_raw}
7272 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7273 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7274 spare areas associated with each data page.
7275 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7276 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7277 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7278 @item @code{oob_only}
7279 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7280 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7281 spare areas associated with each data page.
7282 @end itemize
7283 @end deffn
7284
7285 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7286 @cindex NAND erasing
7287 @cindex NAND programming
7288 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7289 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7290 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7291 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7292 If those parameters are not specified,
7293 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7294 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7295
7296 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7297 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7298 block marker.
7299 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7300 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7301 @end deffn
7302
7303 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7304 @cindex NAND writing
7305 @cindex NAND programming
7306 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7307 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7308 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7309 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7310
7311 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7312 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7313
7314 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7315 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7316 past the end of the device.
7317 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7318 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7319 if that's being written.)
7320
7321 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7322 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7323 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7324
7325 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7326 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7327 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7328 @itemize @bullet
7329 @item no oob_* parameter
7330 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7331 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7332 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7333 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7334 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7335 @item @code{oob_only}
7336 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7337 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7338 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7339 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7340 @item @code{oob_raw}
7341 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7342 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7343 un-altered OOB.
7344 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7345 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7346 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7347 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7348 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7349 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7350 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7351 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7352 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7353 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7354 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7355 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7356 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7357 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7358 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7359 @end itemize
7360 @end deffn
7361
7362 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7363 @cindex NAND verification
7364 @cindex NAND programming
7365 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7366 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7367 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7368
7369 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7370 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7371
7372 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7373 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7374 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7375 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7376 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7377
7378 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7379 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7380 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7381
7382 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7383 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7384 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7385 be removed in a future release.
7386 @end deffn
7387
7388 @subsection Other NAND commands
7389 @cindex NAND other commands
7390
7391 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7392 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7393 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7394 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7395 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7396 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7397 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7398 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7399
7400 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7401 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7402 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7403 @end deffn
7404
7405 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7406 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7407 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7408 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7409 status for each block.
7410 @end deffn
7411
7412 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7413 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7414 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7415
7416 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7417 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7418 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7419 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7420 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7421
7422 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7423 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7424 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7425 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7426 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7427 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7428 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7429 @end deffn
7430
7431 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7432 @subsection NAND Driver List
7433 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7434 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7435 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7436
7437 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7438 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7439 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7440 address of the ECC controller.
7441 @example
7442 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7443 @end example
7444 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7445 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7446 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7447 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7448 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7449 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7450 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7451 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7452 @end deffn
7453 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7454 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7455 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7456 @end deffn
7457
7458 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7459 properly configured for input or output.
7460 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7461 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7462 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7463 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7464 @end deffn
7465 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7466 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7467 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7468 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7469 @end deffn
7470 @end deffn
7471
7472 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7473 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7474 chips from Texas Instruments.
7475 It takes three extra parameters:
7476 address of the NAND chip;
7477 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7478 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7479 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7480 @example
7481 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7482 @end example
7483 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7484 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7485 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7486 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7487 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7488 @end deffn
7489
7490 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7491 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7492 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7493 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7494 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7495 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7496 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7497 @end deffn
7498
7499 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7500 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7501 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7502 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7503 @end deffn
7504 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7505
7506 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7507 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7508 should work for this chip as well.
7509 @end deffn
7510
7511 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7512 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7513 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7514 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7515 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7516 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7517 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7518 @example
7519 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7520 @end example
7521 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7522 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7523 without parameter query status.
7524 @end deffn
7525 @end deffn
7526
7527 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7528 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7529 parameter: the address of the controller.
7530 @example
7531 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7532 @end example
7533 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7534 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7535 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7536 change any behavior.
7537 @end deffn
7538
7539 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7540 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7541 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7542 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7543 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7544 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7545 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7546 specialized commands.
7547 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7548 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7549 change any behavior.
7550 @end deffn
7551
7552 @node Flash Programming
7553 @chapter Flash Programming
7554
7555 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7556 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7557 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7558
7559 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7560 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7561
7562 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7563 @enumerate
7564 @item 'init' is executed.
7565 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7566 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7567 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7568 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7569 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7570 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7571 @end enumerate
7572
7573 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7574
7575 @example
7576 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7577 # are optional parameters
7578 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7579 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7580
7581 # binary files need the flash address passing
7582 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7583 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7584 @end example
7585
7586 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7587 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7588 @cindex PLD
7589 @cindex FPGA
7590
7591 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7592 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7593 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7594 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7595 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7596 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7597 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7598
7599 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7600
7601 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7602 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7603 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7604
7605 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7606 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7607
7608 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7609 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7610 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7611 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7612 behavior.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7616 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7617 @end deffn
7618
7619 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7620 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7621 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7622 @end deffn
7623
7624 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7625
7626 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7627 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7628 that particular type of PLD.
7629
7630 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7631 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7632 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7633
7634 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7635 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7636 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7637
7638 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7639 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7640 for FPGA @var{num}.
7641 @end deffn
7642 @end deffn
7643
7644 @node General Commands
7645 @chapter General Commands
7646 @cindex commands
7647
7648 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7649 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7650 commands are documented elsewhere.
7651
7652 Intent:
7653 @itemize @bullet
7654 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7655 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7656 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7657 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7658
7659 @item @b{From the human}
7660 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7661 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7662
7663 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7664 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7665 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7666
7667 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7668 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7669 port is 5555.
7670 @end itemize
7671
7672
7673 @section Server Commands
7674
7675 @deffn {Command} exit
7676 Exits the current telnet session.
7677 @end deffn
7678
7679 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7680 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7681 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7682 Not every command provides helptext.
7683
7684 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7685 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7686 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7687 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7688 @end deffn
7689
7690 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7691 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7692 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7693 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7694 Useful in connection with script files
7695 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7696 @end deffn
7697
7698 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7699 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7700 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7701 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7702
7703 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7704 @example
7705 # redefine shutdown
7706 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7707 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7708 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7709 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7710 original_shutdown
7711 @}
7712 @end example
7713 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7714 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7715 @end deffn
7716
7717 @anchor{debuglevel}
7718 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7719 @cindex message level
7720 Display debug level.
7721 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7722 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7723 Level 0 is error messages only;
7724 level 1 adds warnings;
7725 level 2 adds informational messages;
7726 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7727 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7728 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7729 the command line along with the location of that log
7730 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7731 @xref{Running}.
7732 @end deffn
7733
7734 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7735 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7736 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7737 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7738 @example
7739 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7740 @end example
7741 @end deffn
7742
7743 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7744 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7745 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7746 @end deffn
7747
7748 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7749 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7750 @end deffn
7751
7752 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7753 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7754 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7755 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7756 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7757 @end deffn
7758
7759 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7760 @section Target State handling
7761 @cindex reset
7762 @cindex halt
7763 @cindex target initialization
7764
7765 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7766 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7767 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7768 a current target which is used to perform the
7769 various operations. The current target may be changed
7770 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7771 target which should become current.
7772
7773 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7774 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7775 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7776 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7777 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7778
7779 @emph{With no arguments}:
7780 list all available registers for the current target,
7781 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7782 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7783 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7784 are flagged as such.
7785
7786 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7787 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7788 bypassing any internal cache.
7789
7790 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7791 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7792 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7793 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7794 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7795 relevant module will flush such values.
7796
7797 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7798 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7799
7800 @example
7801 > reg
7802 ===== ARM registers
7803 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7804 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7805 (2) r2 (/32)
7806 ...
7807 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7808 >
7809 @end example
7810 @end deffn
7811
7812 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7813 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7814 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7815 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7816 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7817 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7818 (and enter debug mode).
7819 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7820
7821 @quotation Warning
7822 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7823 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7824 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7825 power mode by gating the core clock;
7826 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7827
7828 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7829 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7830 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7831 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7832 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7833 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7834
7835 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7836 work with a JTAG debugger.
7837 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7838 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7839 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7840 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7841 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7842 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7843 @end quotation
7844
7845 @end deffn
7846
7847 @deffn Command resume [address]
7848 Resume the target at its current code position,
7849 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7850 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7851 @end deffn
7852
7853 @deffn Command step [address]
7854 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7855 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7856 @end deffn
7857
7858 @anchor{resetcommand}
7859 @deffn Command reset
7860 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7861 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7862 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7863 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7864 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7865 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7866
7867 The optional parameter specifies what should
7868 happen after the reset.
7869 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7870 The other options will not work on all systems.
7871 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7872
7873 @itemize @minus
7874 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7875 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7876 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7877 @end itemize
7878 @end deffn
7879
7880 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7881 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7882 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7883 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7884 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7885 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7886 state.
7887 @end deffn
7888
7889 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7890 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7891 Set values of reset signals.
7892 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
7893 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
7894 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
7895 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
7896
7897 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7898 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
7899 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7900 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7901 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
7902 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
7903 the signal will not be modified.
7904
7905 @quotation Note
7906 TRST is specially handled.
7907 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7908 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7909 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7910 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7911 instead of the TRST signal.
7912 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7913 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7914 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7915 with handlers for that event.
7916 @end quotation
7917 @end deffn
7918
7919 @section I/O Utilities
7920
7921 These commands are available when
7922 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7923 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7924 notably the ZY1000.
7925 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7926
7927 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7928
7929 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7930 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7931 the text file @file{filename}.
7932 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7933 The last string is followed by a newline.
7934 @end deffn
7935
7936 @deffn Command cat filename
7937 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7938 @end deffn
7939
7940 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7941 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7942 into @file{dest_filename}.
7943 @end deffn
7944
7945 @deffn Command ip
7946 @emph{No description provided.}
7947 @end deffn
7948
7949 @deffn Command ls
7950 @emph{No description provided.}
7951 @end deffn
7952
7953 @deffn Command mac
7954 @emph{No description provided.}
7955 @end deffn
7956
7957 @deffn Command meminfo
7958 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7959 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7960 @end deffn
7961
7962 @deffn Command peek
7963 @emph{No description provided.}
7964 @end deffn
7965
7966 @deffn Command poke
7967 @emph{No description provided.}
7968 @end deffn
7969
7970 @deffn Command rm filename
7971 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7972 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7973 @end deffn
7974
7975 @deffn Command trunc filename
7976 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7977 @end deffn
7978
7979 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7980 @section Memory access commands
7981 @cindex memory access
7982
7983 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7984 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7985 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7986 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7987
7988 @enumerate
7989 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7990 to change the current target.
7991 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7992 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7993 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7994 @end enumerate
7995
7996 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
7997 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7998 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7999 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8000 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8001 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8002 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8003 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8004 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8005 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8006 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8007 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8008 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8009 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8010 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8011 @end deffn
8012
8013 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8014 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8015 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8016 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8017 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8018 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8019 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8020 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8021 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8022 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8023 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8024 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8025 @end deffn
8026
8027 @anchor{imageaccess}
8028 @section Image loading commands
8029 @cindex image loading
8030 @cindex image dumping
8031
8032 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8033 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8034 binary file named @var{filename}.
8035 @end deffn
8036
8037 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8038 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8039 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8040 @end deffn
8041
8042 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8043 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8044 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8045 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8046 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8047 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8048 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8049 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8050 separately.
8051 @end deffn
8052
8053 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8054 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8055 The file format may optionally be specified
8056 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8057 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8058 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8059 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8060 @example
8061 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8062 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8063 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8064 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8065 $address $length
8066 @}
8067 @end example
8068 @end deffn
8069
8070 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8071 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8072 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8073 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8074 The file format may optionally be specified
8075 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8076 @end deffn
8077
8078 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8079 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8080 The file format may optionally be specified
8081 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8082 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8083 @end deffn
8084
8085 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8086 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8087 The file format may optionally be specified
8088 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8089 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8090 @end deffn
8091
8092
8093 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8094 @cindex breakpoint
8095 @cindex watchpoint
8096
8097 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8098 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8099 watchpoints.
8100 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8101
8102 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8103 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8104 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8105 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8106 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8107 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8108
8109 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8110 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8111 @end deffn
8112
8113 @deffn Command {rbp} address
8114 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
8115 @end deffn
8116
8117 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8118 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8119 @end deffn
8120
8121 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8122 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8123 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8124 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8125 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8126 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8127 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8128 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8129 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8130 @end deffn
8131
8132 @section Misc Commands
8133
8134 @cindex profiling
8135 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8136 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8137 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8138 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8139 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8140 limit the address range.
8141 @end deffn
8142
8143 @deffn Command {version}
8144 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8145 @end deffn
8146
8147 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8148 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8149 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8150 @end deffn
8151
8152 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8153 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8154 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8155 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8156
8157 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8158 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8159 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8160 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8161
8162 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8163 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8164 @cindex tracing
8165 @cindex ETM
8166 @cindex ETB
8167
8168 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8169 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8170 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8171
8172 @itemize
8173 @item
8174 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8175 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8176 supports such an interface.
8177 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8178 and trace port support.)
8179 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8180 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8181 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8182 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8183 in the board-specific configuration file.
8184 @item
8185 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8186 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8187 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8188 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8189 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8190 @end itemize
8191
8192 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8193
8194 @quotation Issues
8195 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8196 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8197
8198 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8199 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8200 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8201 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8202 dummy trace port driver}.
8203
8204 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8205 as well as tracing only during specific states
8206 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8207
8208 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8209 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8210 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8211 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8212 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8213
8214 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8215 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8216 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8217 this original style of JTAG access.
8218 @end quotation
8219
8220 @subsection ETM Configuration
8221 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8222
8223 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8224 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8225 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8226
8227 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8228 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8229 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8230 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8231 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8232 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8233 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8234 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8235 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8236
8237 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8238 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8239 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8240
8241 @quotation Warning
8242 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8243 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8244 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8245 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8246 @end quotation
8247
8248 @quotation Note
8249 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8250 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8251 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8252 what CPU activities are traced.
8253 @end quotation
8254 @end deffn
8255
8256 @deffn Command {etm info}
8257 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8258 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8259 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8260 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8261 @end deffn
8262
8263 @deffn Command {etm status}
8264 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8265 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8266 Did trace data overflow?
8267 Was it triggered?
8268 @end deffn
8269
8270 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8271 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8272 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8273 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8274 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8275
8276 @itemize
8277 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8278 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8279 The value is one of
8280 @option{none} (save nothing),
8281 @option{data} (save data),
8282 @option{address} (save addresses),
8283 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8284 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8285 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8286 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8287 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8288 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8289 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8290 trace stream without an image of the code.
8291 @end itemize
8292 @end deffn
8293
8294 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8295 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8296 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8297 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8298 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8299
8300 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8301 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8302 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8306
8307 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8308 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8309 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8310
8311 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8312 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8313 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8314 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8315 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8316 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8317 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8318
8319 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8320
8321 @itemize
8322 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8323 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8324 for instruction access within that function's body.
8325 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8326 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8327 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8328 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8329 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8330 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8331 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8332 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8333 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8334 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8335 @item @emph{... more}
8336 @end itemize
8337
8338 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8339 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8340
8341 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8342 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8343 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8344 @end deffn
8345
8346 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8347 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8348 @end deffn
8349
8350 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8351 Opens an image file.
8352 @end deffn
8353
8354 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8355 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8356 @end deffn
8357
8358 @deffn Command {etm start}
8359 Starts trace data collection.
8360 @end deffn
8361
8362 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8363 Stops trace data collection.
8364 @end deffn
8365
8366 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8367 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8368
8369 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8370
8371 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8372 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8373 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8374 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8375 any trace data collection.}
8376 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8377 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8378 @end deffn
8379 @end deffn
8380
8381 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8382 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8383 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8384 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8385 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8386 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8387 @end deffn
8388 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8389 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8390 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8391 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8392 trace trigger becomes active.
8393
8394 @itemize
8395 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8396 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8397 afterwards.
8398 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8399 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8400 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8401 what caused that event to happen.
8402 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8403 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8404 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8405 how the event caused trouble.
8406 @end itemize
8407 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8408 @end deffn
8409
8410 @end deffn
8411
8412 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8413 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8414 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8415 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8416 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8417
8418 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8419 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8420
8421 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8422 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8423 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8424 @end deffn
8425
8426 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8427 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8428 @end deffn
8429
8430 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8431 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8432 @end deffn
8433 @end deffn
8434
8435 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8436 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8437 @cindex CTI
8438
8439 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8440 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8441 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8442 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8443 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8444 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8445
8446 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8447 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8448 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8449 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8450 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8451 including additional configuration.
8452 @end deffn
8453
8454 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8455 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8456 @end deffn
8457
8458 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8459 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8460 @end deffn
8461
8462 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8463 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8464 @end deffn
8465
8466 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8467 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8468 @end deffn
8469
8470 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8471 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8472 @end deffn
8473
8474 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8475 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8476 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8477 @end deffn
8478
8479 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8480 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8481 of the CTI.
8482 @end deffn
8483
8484 @deffn Command {cti names}
8485 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8486 useful in TCL scripting.
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @section Generic ARM
8490 @cindex ARM
8491
8492 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8493 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8494 commands that may be available.
8495
8496 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8497 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8498 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8499 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8500 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8501 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8502 @end deffn
8503
8504 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8505 @cindex disassemble
8506 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8507 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8508 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8509 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8510 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8511 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8512 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8513
8514 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8515 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8516 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8517 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8518 with a handful of exceptions.
8519 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8520 @end deffn
8521
8522 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8523 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8524 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8525 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8526 and using the MCR instruction.
8527 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8528 an ARM register.)
8529 @end deffn
8530
8531 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8532 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8533 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8534 and the MRC instruction.
8535 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8536 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8537 an ARM register.)
8538 @end deffn
8539
8540 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8541 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8542 core mode if necessary.
8543 @end deffn
8544
8545 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8546 @cindex ARM semihosting
8547 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8548
8549 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8550 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8551 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8552 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8553 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8554 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8555 @end deffn
8556
8557 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8558 @cindex ARM semihosting
8559 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8560
8561 @example
8562 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8563 @end example
8564
8565 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8566 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8567 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8568 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8569 @end deffn
8570
8571 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8572 @cindex ARM semihosting
8573 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8574 status.
8575
8576 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8577 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8578 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8579 debugger.
8580 @end deffn
8581
8582 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8583 @cindex ARM semihosting
8584 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8585
8586 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8587 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8588 the value returned by the target.
8589
8590 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8591 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8592 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8593 encountering a break.
8594
8595 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8596 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8597 to the debugger.
8598 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8599 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8600 request or equivalent").
8601
8602 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8603 this option (default: disabled).
8604 @end deffn
8605
8606 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8607 @cindex ARMv4
8608 @cindex ARMv5
8609
8610 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8611 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8612 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8613 variant.
8614
8615 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8616 @cindex ARM7
8617 @cindex ARM9
8618
8619 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8620 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8621 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8622 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8623
8624 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8625 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8626 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8627 instead of breakpoints.
8628 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8629
8630 This should be
8631 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8632 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8633 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8634 @end deffn
8635
8636 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8637 @cindex DCC
8638 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8639 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8640 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8641
8642 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8643 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8644 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8645 @end deffn
8646
8647 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8648 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8649 that don't check completion of the operation.
8650 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8651
8652 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8653 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8654 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8655 @end deffn
8656
8657 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8658 @cindex ARM720T
8659
8660 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8661 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8662 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8663 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8664
8665 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8666 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8667 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8668
8669 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8670 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8671 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8672 @end deffn
8673
8674 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8675 @cindex ARM9
8676
8677 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8678 integer processors.
8679 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8680
8681 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8682 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8683 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8684 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8685
8686 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8687 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8688 @cindex vector_catch
8689 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8690 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8691 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8692 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8693 to those hardware vectors.
8694
8695 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8696 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8697 vector catch hardware to intercept
8698 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8699 @option{none} of them,
8700 or a list with one or more of the following:
8701 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8702 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8703 @end deffn
8704
8705 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8706 @cindex ARM920T
8707
8708 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8709 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8710 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8711 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8712 and ARM9 commands.
8713
8714 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8715 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8716 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8717 @end deffn
8718
8719 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8720 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8721 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8722 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8723 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8724 (Not all registers can be written.)
8725 @end deffn
8726
8727 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8728 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8729 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8730
8731 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8732 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8733 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8734 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8735 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8736 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8737 @end deffn
8738
8739 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8740 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8741 @end deffn
8742
8743 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8744 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8745 @end deffn
8746
8747 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8748 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8749
8750 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8751 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8752 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8753 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8754 and ARM9 commands.
8755
8756 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8757 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8758
8759 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8760 Print information about the caches found.
8761 @end deffn
8762
8763 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8764 @cindex ARM966E
8765
8766 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8767 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8768 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8769 and ARM9 commands.
8770
8771 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8772 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8773 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8774 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8775 ARM966E-S TRM.
8776 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8777 as required for BIST support.
8778 @end deffn
8779
8780 @subsection XScale specific commands
8781 @cindex XScale
8782
8783 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8784
8785 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8786 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8787 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8788 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8789 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8790 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8791 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8792
8793 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8794 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8795 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8796 the mini-IC.
8797
8798 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8799 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8800 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8801 code layout in memory:
8802 @example
8803 _vectors:
8804 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8805 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8806 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8807 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8808 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8809 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8810 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8811 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8812 .org 0x100
8813 .long real_reset_vector
8814 .long real_ui_handler
8815 .long real_swi_handler
8816 .long real_pf_abort
8817 .long real_data_abort
8818 .long 0 /* unused */
8819 .long real_irq_handler
8820 .long real_fiq_handler
8821 @end example
8822
8823 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8824 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8825 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8826 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8827 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8828 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8829 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8830 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8831 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8832 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8833 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8834 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8835 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8836 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8837 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8838 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8839 software.
8840
8841 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8842 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8843 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8844 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8845
8846 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8847 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8848 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8849 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8850 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8851 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8852 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8853 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8854 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8855
8856 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8857 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8858
8859 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8860 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8861 @end deffn
8862
8863 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8864 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8865 @end deffn
8866
8867 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8868 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8869 @end deffn
8870
8871 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8872 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8873 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8874 @end deffn
8875
8876 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8877 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8878 @end deffn
8879
8880 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8881 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8882 @end deffn
8883
8884 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8885 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8886 @end deffn
8887
8888 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8889 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8890 @end deffn
8891
8892 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8893 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8894 @end deffn
8895
8896 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8897 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8898 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8899 and modifying how it is emptied.
8900 @end deffn
8901
8902 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8903 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8904 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8905 The image @var{type} may be one of
8906 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8907 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8908 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8909 @end deffn
8910
8911 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8912 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8913 @cindex vector_catch
8914 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8915 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8916
8917 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8918 @example
8919 0x01 Trap Reset
8920 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8921 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8922 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8923 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8924 0x20 reserved
8925 0x40 Trap IRQ
8926 0x80 Trap FIQ
8927 @end example
8928 @end deffn
8929
8930 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8931 @cindex vector_table
8932
8933 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8934 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8935 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8936 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8937 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8938
8939 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8940
8941 @end deffn
8942
8943 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8944 @cindex ARMv6
8945
8946 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8947 @cindex ARM11
8948
8949 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8950 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8951 which is enabled by default.
8952 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8953 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8954 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8955 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8956 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8957 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8958 @end deffn
8959
8960 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8961 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8962 which is enabled by default.
8963 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8964 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8965 @end deffn
8966
8967 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8968 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8969 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8970 they are disabled by default.
8971 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8972 @end deffn
8973
8974 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8975 @cindex vector_catch
8976 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8977 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8978 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8979
8980 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8981 for certain hardware events.
8982 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8983 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8984 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8985 @end deffn
8986
8987 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8988 @cindex ARMv7
8989 @cindex ARMv8
8990
8991 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8992 @cindex Cortex-A
8993
8994 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8995 display information about target caches
8996 @end deffn
8997
8998 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8999 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9000 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9001 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9002 Defaults to 'off'.
9003 @end deffn
9004
9005 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9006 Initialize core debug
9007 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9008 @end deffn
9009
9010 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9011 Display/set the current SMP mode
9012 @end deffn
9013
9014 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9015 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9016 @end deffn
9017
9018 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9019 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9020 @end deffn
9021
9022 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9023 configure l2x cache
9024 @end deffn
9025
9026 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9027 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9028 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9029 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9030 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9031 @end deffn
9032
9033 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9034 @cindex Cortex-R
9035
9036 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9037 Initialize core debug
9038 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9039 @end deffn
9040
9041 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9042 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9043 @end deffn
9044
9045
9046 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9047 @cindex tracing
9048 @cindex SWO
9049 @cindex SWV
9050 @cindex TPIU
9051 @cindex ITM
9052 @cindex ETM
9053
9054 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9055 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9056 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9057
9058 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9059 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9060 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9061 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9062
9063 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9064 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9065 debugger adapter features.
9066
9067 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9068 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9069
9070 Command options:
9071 @itemize @minus
9072 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9073 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9074 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9075 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9076 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9077 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9078 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9079 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9080 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9081 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9082 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9083 coding;
9084 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9085 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9086 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9087 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9088 data is to be output via SWO;
9089 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9090 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9091 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9092 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9093 rate automatically.
9094 @end itemize
9095
9096 Example usage:
9097 @enumerate
9098 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9099 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9100 enough to:
9101 @example
9102 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9103 ...
9104 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9105 ...
9106 @end example
9107 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9108 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9109 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9110 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9111 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9112 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9113 @example
9114 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9115 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9116 @end example
9117 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9118 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9119 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9120 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9121 @example
9122 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9123 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9124 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9125 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9126 @end example
9127 @end enumerate
9128 @end deffn
9129
9130 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9131 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9132 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9133 @end deffn
9134
9135 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9136 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9137 @end deffn
9138
9139 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9140 @cindex Cortex-M
9141
9142 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9143 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9144
9145 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9146 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9147 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9148 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9149 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9150 the step command leaves with the core running.
9151
9152 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9153 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9154 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9155 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9156
9157 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9158 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9159 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9160 does.
9161
9162 Default is @option{auto}.
9163 @end deffn
9164
9165 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9166 @cindex vector_catch
9167 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9168 for certain hardware events.
9169
9170 Parameters request interception of
9171 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9172 @option{none} of them,
9173 or one or more of the following:
9174 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9175 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9176 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9177 @option{irq_err},
9178 @option{state_err},
9179 @option{chk_err}, or
9180 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9181 @option{reset}.
9182 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9183 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9184 are mapped to HardFault.
9185 UsageFault checks for
9186 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9187 must also be explicitly enabled.
9188
9189 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9190 @end deffn
9191
9192 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9193 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9194 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9195
9196 @itemize @minus
9197 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9198 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9199 @end itemize
9200
9201 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9202 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9203 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9204 to manually reset the peripherals.
9205 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9206
9207 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9208 instead.
9209 @end deffn
9210
9211 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9212 @cindex ARMv8-A
9213 @cindex aarch64
9214
9215 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9216 Display information about target caches
9217 @end deffn
9218
9219 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9220 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9221 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9222 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9223 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9224 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9225 @end deffn
9226
9227 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9228 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9229 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9230 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9231 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9232 @end deffn
9233
9234 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9235 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9236 @option{on}.
9237 @end deffn
9238
9239 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9240 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9241 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9242 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9243 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9244 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9245 @end deffn
9246
9247 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9248
9249 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9250 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9251
9252 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9253
9254 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9255 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9256 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9257 @end deffn
9258
9259 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9260 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9261 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9262 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9263 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9264 @end deffn
9265
9266 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9267
9268 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9269 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9270 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9271 @end deffn
9272
9273 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9274
9275 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9276 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9277 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9278 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9279 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9280 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9281 can be collected.
9282
9283 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9284 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9285 tooling.
9286
9287 @quotation Issues
9288 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9289 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9290 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9291 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9292
9293 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9294 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9295 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9296 software operation on the CPU.
9297 @end quotation
9298
9299 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9300 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9301 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9302 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9303 @end deffn
9304
9305 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9306 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9307 @end deffn
9308
9309 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9310 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9311 control is disabled.
9312 @end deffn
9313
9314 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9315 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9316 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9317 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9318
9319 Supported trace formats:
9320 @itemize
9321 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9322 timing to be determined.
9323 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9324 addresses.
9325 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9326 @end itemize
9327 @end deffn
9328
9329 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9330 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9331 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9332 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9333
9334 Supported conditions:
9335 @itemize
9336 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9337 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9338 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9339 instruction matches start data and mask.
9340 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9341 instruction matches start data and mask.
9342 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9343 data and mask.
9344 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9345 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9346 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9347 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9348 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9349 @end itemize
9350 @end deffn
9351
9352 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9353 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9354 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9355 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9356
9357 Supported conditions:
9358 @itemize
9359 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9360 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9361 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9362 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9363 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9364 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9365 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9366 data and mask.
9367 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9368 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9369 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9370 @end itemize
9371 @end deffn
9372
9373 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9374 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9375
9376 Supported triggers:
9377 @itemize
9378 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9379 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9380 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9381 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9382 collection.
9383 @end itemize
9384 @end deffn
9385
9386 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9387
9388 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9389 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9390 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9391 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9392 @end deffn
9393
9394 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9395 Display trace configuration.
9396 @end deffn
9397
9398 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9399 Display trace collection status.
9400 @end deffn
9401
9402 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9403 Start manual trace collection.
9404 @end deffn
9405
9406 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9407 Stop manual trace collection.
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9411 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9412 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9413 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9414 @option{size} options using DMA.
9415 @end deffn
9416
9417 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9418 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9419 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9420 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9421 @option{size} options using DMA.
9422 @end deffn
9423
9424 @section Intel Architecture
9425
9426 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9427 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9428 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9429 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9430 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9431 @itemize
9432 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9433 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9434 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9435 @end itemize
9436
9437 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9438 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9439 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9440
9441 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9442 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9443 @end deffn
9444
9445 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9446 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9447 @end deffn
9448
9449 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9450 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9451 @end deffn
9452
9453 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9454 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9455 @end deffn
9456
9457 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9458 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9459 @end deffn
9460
9461 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9462 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9463 @end deffn
9464
9465 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9466
9467 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9468 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9469
9470 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9471 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9472 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9473 @end deffn
9474 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9475 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9476
9477 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9478
9479 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9480 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9481 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9482 @end deffn
9483
9484 @subsection Registers commands
9485 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9486 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9487 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9488
9489 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9490
9491 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9492 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9493 and "timer" groups.
9494
9495 @emph{example:}
9496 @example
9497 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9498 @end example
9499
9500
9501 @end deffn
9502 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9503 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9504
9505 @emph{group} can be "system",
9506 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9507 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9508 @end deffn
9509
9510 @section RISC-V Architecture
9511
9512 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9513 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9514 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9515 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9516 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9517 implement version 0.11.
9518
9519 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9520
9521 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9522 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9523 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9524
9525 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9526
9527 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9528 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9529 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9530
9531 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9532 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9533 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9534 CSRs.
9535 @end deffn
9536
9537 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9538 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9539 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9540 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9541 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9542 This command must be executed before `init`.
9543 @end deffn
9544
9545 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9546 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9547 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9548 @end deffn
9549
9550 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9551 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9552 deasserted.
9553 @end deffn
9554
9555 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9556 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9557 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9558 @end deffn
9559
9560 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9561 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9562 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9563 @end deffn
9564
9565 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9566 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9567 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9568 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9569 values.
9570
9571 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9572 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9573 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9574 @end deffn
9575
9576 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9577
9578 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9579 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9580 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9581 @example
9582 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9583 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9584 @end example
9585
9586 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9587 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9588 @end deffn
9589
9590 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9591 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9592 @end deffn
9593
9594 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9595
9596 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9597 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9598
9599 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9600 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9601 @end deffn
9602
9603 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9604 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9605 @end deffn
9606
9607 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9608 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9609 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9610 @cindex tracing
9611 @cindex libdcc
9612 @cindex DCC
9613 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9614 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9615 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9616 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9617
9618 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9619 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9620 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9621 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9622 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9623 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9624
9625 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9626 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9627 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9628 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9629 The target being debugged may
9630 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9631 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9632 each supported by a command:
9633
9634 @itemize
9635 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9636 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9637 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9638 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9639
9640 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9641 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9642 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9643
9644 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9645 and then displayed at any time.
9646 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9647
9648 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9649 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9650 @end itemize
9651
9652 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9653 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9654 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9655 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9656 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9657 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9658 does the same thing.
9659
9660 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9661 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9662 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9663 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9664 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9665
9666 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9667 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9668 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9669 @end deffn
9670
9671 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9672 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9673 in the order they triggered.
9674 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9675 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9676 history records.
9677 @end deffn
9678
9679 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9680 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9681 they have been triggered.
9682 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9683 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9684 and associates it with that identifier.
9685
9686 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9687 are not related except by this command.
9688 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9689 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9690 @end deffn
9691
9692
9693 @node JTAG Commands
9694 @chapter JTAG Commands
9695 @cindex JTAG Commands
9696 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9697 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9698 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9699 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9700 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9701
9702 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9703 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9704
9705 @itemize @bullet
9706 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9707 devices such as a CPUs.
9708 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9709 standard state machine (in parallel)
9710 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9711 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9712 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9713 while the reading previous ones.
9714 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9715 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9716 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9717 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9718 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9719 registers.
9720 @end itemize
9721
9722 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9723
9724 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9725 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9726 the order of TAP state transitions.
9727 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9728 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9729 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9730 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9731 these commands are not available.
9732
9733 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9734 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9735 that specify the entire register.
9736 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9737 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9738 The return value holds the original value of each
9739 of those fields.
9740
9741 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9742 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9743 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9744 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9745 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9746
9747 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9748 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9749
9750 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9751 in that state.
9752 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9753 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9754 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9755
9756 @quotation Warning
9757 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9758 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9759 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9760 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9761 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9762 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9763 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9764 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9765 @end quotation
9766 @end deffn
9767
9768 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9769 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9770 This may be used for performance tuning.
9771
9772 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9773 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9774 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9775 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9776 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9777 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9778 @end deffn
9779
9780 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9781 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9782 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9783 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9784 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9785 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9786
9787 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9788 in that state.
9789 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9790 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9791 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9792
9793 @quotation Note
9794 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9795 register values, unlike data register values.
9796 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9797 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9798 @end quotation
9799 @end deffn
9800
9801 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9802 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9803 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9804 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9805 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9806 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9807 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9808 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9809 The final state must also be stable.
9810 @end deffn
9811
9812 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9813 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9814 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9815 Instructions often need some time
9816 to execute before they take effect.
9817 @end deffn
9818
9819 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9820 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9821
9822 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9823 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9824 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9825 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9826 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9827 @end deffn
9828
9829 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9830 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9831 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9832 must also be enabled.
9833 Default is enabled.
9834 @end deffn
9835
9836 @section TAP state names
9837 @cindex TAP state names
9838
9839 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9840 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9841 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9842 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9843
9844 @itemize @bullet
9845 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9846 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9847 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9848 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9849 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9850 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9851 through the data register
9852 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9853 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9854 for update or more shifting
9855 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9856 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9857 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9858 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9859 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9860 through the instruction register
9861 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9862 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9863 for update or more shifting
9864 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9865 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9866 @end itemize
9867
9868 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9869 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9870 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9871 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9872
9873 @itemize @bullet
9874 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9875 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9876 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9877 may not be as expected.
9878 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9879 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9880 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9881 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9882 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9883 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9884 @end itemize
9885
9886 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9887 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9888
9889 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9890 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9891 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9892 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9893
9894 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9895 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9896 @cindex SVF
9897
9898 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9899 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9900 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9901 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9902
9903 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9904 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9905 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9906 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9907
9908 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9909 affect their semantics.
9910
9911 Command options:
9912 @itemize @minus
9913 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9914 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9915 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9916 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9917 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9918 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9919 on the real interface;
9920 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9921 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9922 errors.
9923 @end itemize
9924 @end deffn
9925
9926 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9927 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9928 @cindex XSVF
9929
9930 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9931 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9932 Xilinx devices.
9933 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9934 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9935
9936 @quotation Important
9937 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9938 @end quotation
9939
9940 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9941 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9942 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9943 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9944 that TAP.
9945 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9946 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9947 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9948 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9949 @end deffn
9950
9951 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9952 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9953 after building the software.
9954 You may find them useful:
9955
9956 @itemize
9957 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9958 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9959 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9960 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9961 @end itemize
9962
9963 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9964 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9965 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9966 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9967 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9968 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9969 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9970
9971
9972 @node Utility Commands
9973 @chapter Utility Commands
9974 @cindex Utility Commands
9975
9976 @section RAM testing
9977 @cindex RAM testing
9978
9979 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9980 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9981 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9982 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9983 hardware problems.
9984
9985 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9986 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9987 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9988 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9989
9990 Load the memory testing functions with
9991
9992 @example
9993 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9994 @end example
9995
9996 to get access to the following facilities:
9997
9998 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9999 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10000 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10001 @end deffn
10002
10003 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10004 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10005 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10006 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10007 @end deffn
10008
10009 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10010 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10011 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10012 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10013 @end deffn
10014
10015 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10016 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10017 @end deffn
10018
10019 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10020 @cindex Firmware recovery
10021
10022 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10023 devices recovery with JTAG.
10024
10025 For quickstart instructions run:
10026 @example
10027 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10028 @end example
10029
10030 @node TFTP
10031 @chapter TFTP
10032 @cindex TFTP
10033 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10034 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10035
10036 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10037 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10038 server (tftpd). For example,
10039
10040 @example
10041 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10042 @end example
10043
10044 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10045 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10046
10047 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10048 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10049 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10050 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10051
10052 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10053 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10054 @cindex GDB
10055 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10056 to debug remote targets.
10057 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10058
10059 @itemize
10060 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10061 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10062 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10063 as shown in this chapter.
10064 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10065 that also will probably need to be configured.
10066 @end itemize
10067
10068 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10069 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10070 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10071 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10072 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10073 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10074
10075 @section Connecting to GDB
10076 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10077 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10078 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10079 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10080 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10081
10082 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10083
10084 @enumerate
10085 @item
10086 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10087 @example
10088 target remote localhost:3333
10089 @end example
10090 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10091
10092 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
10093 @example
10094 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10095 @end example
10096 @item
10097 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10098 @example
10099 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10100 @end example
10101 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10102 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10103 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10104 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10105 @end enumerate
10106
10107 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10108 GDB command line.
10109
10110 @section Sample GDB session startup
10111
10112 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10113 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10114 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10115 small ARM program.
10116 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10117 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10118
10119 @example
10120 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10121 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
10122 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10123 ...
10124 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10125 ...
10126 (gdb) load
10127 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10128 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10129 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10130 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10131 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10132 (gdb) continue
10133 Continuing.
10134 ...
10135 @end example
10136
10137 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10138 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10139 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10140 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10141
10142 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10143
10144 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10145 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10146 packet size and the device's memory map.
10147 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10148 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10149 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10150
10151 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10152 You may need to set those up by hand.
10153 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10154 something like:
10155
10156 @example
10157 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10158 @end example
10159
10160 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10161
10162 @example
10163 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10164 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10165 @end example
10166
10167 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10168 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10169 do not have such restrictions.
10170
10171 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10172 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10173 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10174 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10175
10176 @section Programming using GDB
10177 @cindex Programming using GDB
10178 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10179
10180 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10181 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10182 @example
10183 gdb_memory_map disable
10184 @end example
10185 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10186 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10187 working area.
10188
10189 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10190 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10191 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10192 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10193
10194 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10195 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10196
10197 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10198 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10199 @example
10200 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10201 @end example
10202
10203 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10204 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10205
10206 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10207 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10208 will be used.
10209
10210 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10211 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10212 @example
10213 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10214 @end example
10215 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10216
10217 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10218 can be used.
10219
10220 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10221 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10222 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10223
10224 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10225 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10226 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10227
10228 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10229 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10230 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10231 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10232 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10233 without any intrusion of the target process.
10234
10235 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10236 Place following command after target configuration:
10237 @example
10238 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10239 @end example
10240
10241 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10242 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10243 @example
10244 gdb_memory_map disable
10245 @end example
10246
10247 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10248 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10249 @example
10250 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10251 @end example
10252
10253 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10254 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10255
10256 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10257 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10258 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10259 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10260
10261 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10262 previously shown varibles.
10263
10264 @section RTOS Support
10265 @cindex RTOS Support
10266 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10267
10268 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10269 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10270
10271 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10272 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10273 GDB commands.
10274
10275 @* An example setup is below:
10276
10277 @example
10278 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10279 @end example
10280
10281 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10282
10283 Currently supported rtos's include:
10284 @itemize @bullet
10285 @item @option{eCos}
10286 @item @option{ThreadX}
10287 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10288 @item @option{linux}
10289 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10290 @item @option{embKernel}
10291 @item @option{mqx}
10292 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10293 @item @option{nuttx}
10294 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10295 @end itemize
10296
10297 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10298 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10299
10300 @table @code
10301 @item eCos symbols
10302 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10303 @item ThreadX symbols
10304 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10305 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10306 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10307 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10308 @tex
10309 \begingroup
10310 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10311 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10312 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10313 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10314 \par
10315 \endgroup
10316 @end tex
10317 @item linux symbols
10318 init_task.
10319 @item ChibiOS symbols
10320 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10321 @item embKernel symbols
10322 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10323 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10324 @item mqx symbols
10325 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10326 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10327 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10328 @item nuttx symbols
10329 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10330 @end table
10331
10332 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10333 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10334
10335 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10336 along with the project:
10337
10338 @table @code
10339 @item FreeRTOS
10340 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10341 @item uC/OS-III
10342 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10343 @end table
10344
10345 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10346 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10347 @cindex SMP
10348 @cindex RTOS
10349 @cindex hwthread
10350 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10351 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10352 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10353 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10354 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10355 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10356 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10357 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10358 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10359
10360 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10361 @quotation Note
10362 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10363 @end quotation
10364
10365 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10366 @itemize @bullet
10367 @item j - smp status request
10368 @item J - smp set request
10369 @end itemize
10370
10371 OpenOCD implements :
10372 @itemize @bullet
10373 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10374 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10375 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10376 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10377 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10378 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10379 @end itemize
10380
10381 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10382 @itemize @bullet
10383 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10384 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10385 @example
10386 set $_core 1
10387 #Jc01 packet is sent
10388 print $_core
10389 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10390 @end example
10391
10392 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10393 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10394
10395 @example
10396 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10397 define toggle0
10398 maint packet Jc0
10399 continue
10400 main packet Jc-1
10401 end
10402 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10403 define toggle1
10404 maint packet Jc1
10405 continue
10406 main packet Jc-1
10407 end
10408 @end example
10409 @end itemize
10410
10411 @node Tcl Scripting API
10412 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10413 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10414 @cindex Tcl scripts
10415 @section API rules
10416
10417 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10418 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10419 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10420
10421 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10422 pair list and lists.
10423
10424 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10425 list.
10426
10427 @example
10428 > set foo(me) Duane
10429 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10430 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10431 > set foo(duck) Donald
10432 @end example
10433
10434 If one does this:
10435
10436 @example
10437 > set foo
10438 @end example
10439
10440 The result is:
10441
10442 @example
10443 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10444 @end example
10445
10446 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10447
10448 @verbatim
10449 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10450 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10451 }
10452 @end verbatim
10453
10454 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10455 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10456
10457 @section Internal low-level Commands
10458
10459 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10460 invoke directly.
10461
10462 @itemize @bullet
10463 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10464
10465 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10466 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10467
10468 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10469 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10470
10471 Return information about the flash banks
10472
10473 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10474
10475 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10476 its execution. Example:
10477
10478 @example
10479 > capture "reset init"
10480 @end example
10481
10482 @end itemize
10483
10484 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10485 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10486 called "flash_banks".
10487
10488 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10489
10490 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10491 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10492 holds one of the following values:
10493
10494 @itemize @bullet
10495 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10496 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10497 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10498 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10499 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10500 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10501 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10502 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10503 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10504 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10505 @end itemize
10506
10507 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10508
10509 @quotation Note
10510 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10511 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10512 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10513 is jim, not real tcl).
10514 @end quotation
10515
10516 @section Tcl RPC server
10517 @cindex RPC
10518
10519 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10520 commands and receive the results.
10521
10522 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10523 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10524 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10525 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10526 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10527
10528 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10529 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10530 @command{capture} command.
10531
10532 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10533
10534 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10535 @cindex RPC Notifications
10536
10537 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10538 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10539
10540 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10541 in the following format.
10542
10543 @verbatim
10544 type target_event event [event-name]
10545 type target_state state [state-name]
10546 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10547 @end verbatim
10548
10549 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10550 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10551 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10552 Defaults to off.
10553
10554 @end deffn
10555
10556 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10557 @cindex RPC trace output
10558
10559 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10560 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10561
10562 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10563
10564 @verbatim
10565 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10566 @end verbatim
10567
10568 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10569 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10570 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10571 Defaults to off.
10572
10573 See an example application here:
10574 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10575
10576 @end deffn
10577
10578 @node FAQ
10579 @chapter FAQ
10580 @cindex faq
10581 @enumerate
10582 @anchor{faqrtck}
10583 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10584 @cindex RTCK
10585 @cindex adaptive clocking
10586 @*
10587
10588 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10589 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10590 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10591 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10592
10593 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10594 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10595 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10596 @enumerate
10597 @item
10598 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10599 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10600 @item
10601 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10602 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10603 @end enumerate
10604
10605 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10606 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10607 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10608 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10609 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10610 power).
10611
10612 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10613 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10614 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10615 ARM926 scenario).
10616 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10617 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10618 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10619
10620 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10621 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10622 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10623 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10624
10625 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10626
10627 In order to make use of this,
10628 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10629 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10630
10631 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10632 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10633 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10634 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10635 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10636
10637 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10638 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10639 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10640 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10641
10642 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10643 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10644 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10645 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10646 with a CPLD.
10647 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10648 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10649 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10650 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10651 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10652 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10653
10654 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10655
10656 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10657
10658 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10659 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10660 depending on the chips on your board.
10661 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10662 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10663 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10664
10665 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10666 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10667 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10668
10669 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10670 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10671 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10672 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10673
10674 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10675 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10676 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10677 this way.
10678
10679 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10680 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10681 clock rate.
10682 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10683 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10684 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10685
10686 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10687
10688 @example
10689 # Example: 1.234MHz
10690 adapter_khz 1234
10691 @end example
10692
10693
10694 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10695
10696 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10697 around Windows filenames.
10698
10699 @example
10700 > echo \a
10701
10702 > echo @{\a@}
10703 \a
10704 > echo "\a"
10705
10706 >
10707 @end example
10708
10709
10710 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10711
10712 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10713 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10714 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10715
10716 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10717 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10718 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10719
10720 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10721 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10722 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10723
10724 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10725
10726 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10727 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10728 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10729 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10730
10731 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10732 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10733 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10734
10735 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10736 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10737
10738 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10739 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10740 memory read caused data abort".
10741
10742 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10743 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10744 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10745 be done, feel free to add this here.
10746
10747 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10748 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10749 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10750 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10751 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10752 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10753 gracefully stops.
10754
10755 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10756 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10757 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10758
10759 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10760 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10761 bytes. Painful...
10762
10763
10764 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10765 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10766
10767 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10768 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
10769 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10770 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10771 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10772 reset, everything else should work fine.
10773
10774 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10775 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10776 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10777 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10778
10779 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10780 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10781 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10782 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10783
10784 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10785
10786 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10787 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10788 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10789
10790 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10791 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10792
10793 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10794 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10795 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10796 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10797 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10798 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10799 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10800 clock frequency?
10801
10802 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10803 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10804 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10805 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10806 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10807
10808 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10809
10810 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10811 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10812 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10813 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10814 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10815 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10816 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10817
10818 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10819
10820 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10821 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10822 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10823 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10824
10825 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10826 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10827 particular order?
10828
10829 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10830 the same order used by the hardware.
10831
10832 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10833 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10834 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10835 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10836 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10837 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10838
10839 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10840 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10841 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10842 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10843
10844 @itemize @bullet
10845 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10846 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10847 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10848 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10849 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10850 @end itemize
10851
10852 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10853
10854 @itemize @bullet
10855 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10856 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10857 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10858 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10859 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10860 @end itemize
10861
10862
10863 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10864 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10865 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10866
10867 TODO.
10868
10869 @end enumerate
10870
10871 @node Tcl Crash Course
10872 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10873 @cindex Tcl
10874
10875 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10876 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10877 how the Tcl scripts work.
10878
10879 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10880 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10881 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10882 OpenOCD.
10883
10884 @section Tcl Rule #1
10885 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10886 @enumerate
10887 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10888 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10889 @end enumerate
10890
10891 The Tcl equal is this:
10892
10893 @enumerate
10894 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10895 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10896 @end enumerate
10897
10898 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10899 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10900
10901 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10902 There is a second pair of rules.
10903 @enumerate
10904 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10905 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10906 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10907 in Tcl.
10908 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10909 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10910 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10911 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10912 @end enumerate
10913
10914 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10915 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10916 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10917 Everything is a string}
10918
10919 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10920 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10921 difference is subtle.
10922 @enumerate
10923 @item Parse Time
10924 @item Evaluation Time
10925 @end enumerate
10926
10927 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10928 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10929 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10930
10931 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10932 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10933 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10934 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10935
10936 @itemize @bullet
10937 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10938 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10939 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10940 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10941 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10942 @example
10943 # bash example
10944 X=`date`
10945 echo "The Date is: $X"
10946 # Tcl example
10947 set X [date]
10948 puts "The Date is: $X"
10949 @end example
10950 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10951 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10952 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10953 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10954 is a string}
10955 @example
10956 set x "Dinner"
10957 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10958 @end example
10959 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10960 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10961 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10962 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10963 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10964 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10965 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10966 @end itemize
10967
10968 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10969
10970 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10971
10972 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10973
10974 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10975 the normal way.
10976
10977 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10978 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10979 line is immediately executed.
10980
10981 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10982 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10983
10984 @subsection Command Execution
10985
10986 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10987 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10988 control flow operators.
10989
10990 Commands are executed like this:
10991
10992 @enumerate
10993 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10994 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10995 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10996 @end enumerate
10997
10998 It sort of works like this:
10999 @example
11000 for(;;)@{
11001 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11002
11003 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11004
11005 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11006 @}
11007 @end example
11008
11009 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11010 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11011 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11012 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11013 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11014 ``LookupCommand()''
11015
11016 @subsection The FOR command
11017
11018 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11019 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11020 command just like any other command.
11021
11022 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11023 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11024 are:
11025
11026 @enumerate 0
11027 @item The ascii text 'for'
11028 @item The start text
11029 @item The test expression
11030 @item The next text
11031 @item The body text
11032 @end enumerate
11033
11034 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11035 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11036 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11037 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11038
11039 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11040 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11041
11042 @example
11043 int
11044 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11045 int *argc,
11046 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11047 @end example
11048
11049 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11050 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11051 still operates in the same basic way.
11052
11053 @subsection FOR command implementation
11054
11055 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11056 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11057
11058 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11059
11060 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11061
11062 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11063 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11064 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11065
11066 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11067 expression and returns a value.
11068
11069 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11070 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11071 @example
11072 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11073
11074 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11075
11076 int
11077 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11078 int argc,
11079 char **argv )
11080 @{
11081 if( argc != 5 )@{
11082 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11083 return ERROR;
11084 @}
11085
11086 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11087
11088 // Execute the start statement.
11089 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11090
11091 // Top of loop test
11092 for(;;)@{
11093 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11094 if( i == 0 )
11095 break;
11096
11097 // Execute the body
11098 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11099
11100 // Execute the LOOP part
11101 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11102 @}
11103
11104 // Return no error
11105 SetResult( interp, "" );
11106 return SUCCESS;
11107 @}
11108 @end example
11109
11110 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11111 in the same basic way.
11112
11113 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11114
11115 @subsection source and find commands
11116 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11117 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11118 @*Remember the parsing rules
11119 @enumerate
11120 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11121 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11122 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11123 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11124 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11125 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11126 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11127 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11128 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11129 @end enumerate
11130 @subsection format command
11131 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11132 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11133 @b{sprintf()}.
11134 @b{Example}
11135 @example
11136 set x 6
11137 set y 7
11138 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11139 @end example
11140 @enumerate
11141 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11142 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11143 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11144 @* Refer to Rule #1
11145 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11146 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11147 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11148 @end enumerate
11149 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11150 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11151 @example
11152 #1 Good
11153 proc someproc @{@} @{
11154 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11155 @}
11156 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11157 #2 Good - no variables
11158 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11159 #3 Good Curly Braces
11160 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11161 puts "Time: [date]"
11162 @}
11163 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11164 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11165 @end example
11166 @enumerate
11167 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11168 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11169 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11170 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11171 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11172 command.
11173 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11174 @*There are 4 examples:
11175 @enumerate
11176 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11177 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11178 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11179 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11180 @end enumerate
11181
11182 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11183 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11184 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11185
11186 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11187 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11188 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11189 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11190 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11191 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11192 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11193 @end enumerate
11194 @subsection Global Variables
11195 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11196 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11197 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11198 @example
11199 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11200 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11201 global x #Global variable X
11202 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11203 @}
11204 @end example
11205 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11206 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11207 @example
11208 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11209 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11210 # Create var name
11211 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11212 # Make it a global
11213 global $vn
11214 # Set it.
11215 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11216 @}
11217 @end example
11218 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11219 @example
11220 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11221 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11222 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11223 @}
11224 @end example
11225
11226 @include fdl.texi
11227
11228 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11229 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11230 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11231 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11232 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11233 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11234
11235 @printindex cp
11236
11237 @node Command and Driver Index
11238 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11239 @printindex fn
11240
11241 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)